systems and methods are described for customizable data streams in a streaming data processing system. Routing criteria for the customizable data streams are defined by a user, an automated process, or any other process. The routing criteria can be defined using graphical controls. The streaming data processing system uses the routing criteria to determine data that should be used to populate a particular data stream. Further, processing pipelines are customized such that a particular processing pipeline can obtain data from a particular user defined data stream and write data to a particular user defined data stream. data is routed through the user defined data streams and customized processing pipelines based on a data route. A data route for a set of data may include multiple user defined data streams and multiple processing pipelines. The data route can include a loop of processing pipelines and data streams.
|
1. A method, comprising:
causing display of a first graphical control of a graphical user interface on a display device, the first graphical control enabling a user to define one or more data streams;
causing display of a second graphical control of the graphical user interface on the display device, the second graphical control enabling the user to define one or more processing pipelines, the second graphical control further enabling the user to specify a data route that comprises the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines;
implementing the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines based on the data route, wherein each processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines performs one or more corresponding data transformations based on input obtained via the second graphical control, wherein each data stream of the one or more data streams, based on input obtained via the first graphical control:
obtains data from one or more of a first processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines or a data source and writes the data to a second processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines, or
obtains data from a first processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines and writes the data to a second processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines or a data sink; and
routing a set of data based at least in part on the data route specified by the second graphical control.
13. A computing system comprising:
memory;
a display device; and
one or more processing devices coupled to the memory and configured to:
cause display of a first graphical control of a first graphical user interface on the display device, the first graphical control enabling a user to define one or more data streams;
cause display of a second graphical control of a second graphical user interface on the display device, the second graphical control enabling the user to define one or more processing pipelines, the second graphical control further enabling the user to specify a data route that comprises the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines;
implement the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines based on the data route, wherein each processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines performs one or more corresponding data transformations based on input obtained via the second graphical control, wherein each data stream of the one or more data streams, based on input obtained via the first graphical control:
obtains data from one or more of a first processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines or a data source and writes the data to a second processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines, or
obtains data from a first processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines and writes the data to a second processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines or a data sink; and
route a set of data based at least in part on the data route specified by the second graphical control.
17. Non-transitory computer readable media comprising computer-executable instructions that, when executed by a computing system of a streaming data processing system, cause the computing system to:
cause display of a first graphical control of a first graphical user interface on a display device, the first graphical control enabling a user to define one or more data streams;
cause display of a second graphical control of a second graphical user interface on the display device, the second graphical control enabling the user to define one or more processing pipelines, the second graphical control further enabling the user to specify a data route that comprises the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines;
implement the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines based on the data route, wherein each processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines performs one or more corresponding data transformations based on input obtained via the second graphical control, wherein each data stream of the one or more data streams, based on input obtained via the first graphical control:
obtains data from one or more of a first processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines or a data source and writes the data to a second processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines, or
obtains data from a first processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines and writes the data to a second processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines or a data sink; and
route a set of data based at least in part on the data route specified by the second graphical control.
2. The method of
3. The method of
4. The method of
5. The method of
6. The method of
7. The method of
8. The method of
9. The method of
11. The method of
12. The method of
14. The computing system of
15. The computing system of
16. The computing system of
18. The non-transitory computer readable media of
19. The non-transitory computer readable media of
20. The non-transitory computer readable media of
|
Any and all applications for which a foreign or domestic priority claim is identified in the Application Data Sheet as filed with the present application are incorporated by reference under 37 CFR 1.57 and made a part of this specification. This application claims the benefit of priority of U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 63/143,706, filed Jan. 29, 2021, entitled “USER DEFINED STREAMS FOR PROCESSING PIPELINES,” which is hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety and for all purposes.
This application is being filed concurrently with the following U.S. Applications, each of which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety:
U.S.
application
Filing
No.
Title
Date
17/243,128
A USER DEFINED DATA STREAM
Apr. 28, 2021
FOR ROUTING DATA
17/243,209
ROUTING DATA BETWEEN
Apr. 28, 2021
PROCESSING PIPELINES VIA A
USER DEFINED DATA STREAM
At least one embodiment of the present disclosure pertains to one or more tools for facilitating searching and analyzing large sets of data to locate data of interest.
Information technology (IT) environments can include diverse types of data systems that store large amounts of diverse data types generated by numerous devices. For example, a big data ecosystem may include databases such as MySQL and Oracle databases, cloud computing services such as Amazon web services (AWS), and other data systems that store passively or actively generated data, including machine-generated data (“machine data”). The machine data can include performance data, diagnostic data, or any other data that can be analyzed to diagnose equipment performance problems, monitor user interactions, and to derive other insights.
The large amount and diversity of data systems containing large amounts of structured, semi-structured, and unstructured data relevant to any search query can be massive, and continues to grow rapidly. This technological evolution can give rise to various challenges in relation to managing, understanding and effectively utilizing the data. To reduce the potentially vast amount of data that may be generated, some data systems pre-process data based on anticipated data analysis needs. In particular, specified data items may be extracted from the generated data and stored in a data system to facilitate efficient retrieval and analysis of those data items at a later time. At least some of the remainder of the generated data is typically discarded during pre-processing.
However, storing massive quantities of minimally processed or unprocessed data (collectively and individually referred to as “raw data”) for later retrieval and analysis is becoming increasingly more feasible as storage capacity becomes more inexpensive and plentiful. In general, storing raw data and performing analysis on that data later can provide greater flexibility because it enables an analyst to analyze all of the generated data instead of only a fraction of it.
Although the availability of vastly greater amounts of diverse data on diverse data systems provides opportunities to derive new insights, it also gives rise to technical challenges to search and analyze the data. Tools exist that allow an analyst to search data systems separately and collect results over a network for the analyst to derive insights in a piecemeal manner. However, UI tools that allow analysts to quickly search and analyze large set of raw machine data to visually identify data subsets of interest, particularly via straightforward and easy-to-understand sets of tools and search functionality do not exist.
The present disclosure is illustrated by way of example, and not limitation, in the figures of the accompanying drawings, in which like reference numerals indicate similar elements.
Embodiments are described herein according to the following outline:
1.0. General Overview
2.0. Operating Environment
3.0. Data Intake and Query System Architecture
4.0. Data Intake and Query System Functions
5.0. User-Defined Data Streams
Modern data centers and other computing environments can comprise anywhere from a few host computer systems to thousands of systems configured to process data, service requests from remote clients, and perform numerous other computational tasks. During operation, various components within these computing environments often generate significant volumes of machine data. Machine data is any data produced by a machine or component in an information technology (IT) environment and that reflects activity in the IT environment. For example, machine data can be raw machine data that is generated by various components in IT environments, such as servers, sensors, routers, mobile devices, Internet of Things (IoT) devices, etc. Machine data can include system logs, network packet data, sensor data, application program data, error logs, stack traces, system performance data, etc. In general, machine data can also include performance data, diagnostic information, and many other types of data that can be analyzed to diagnose performance problems, monitor user interactions, and to derive other insights.
A number of tools are available to analyze machine data. In order to reduce the size of the potentially vast amount of machine data that may be generated, many of these tools typically pre-process the data based on anticipated data-analysis needs. For example, pre-specified data items may be extracted from the machine data and stored in a database to facilitate efficient retrieval and analysis of those data items at search time. However, the rest of the machine data typically is not saved and is discarded during pre-processing. As storage capacity becomes progressively cheaper and more plentiful, there are fewer incentives to discard these portions of machine data and many reasons to retain more of the data.
This plentiful storage capacity is presently making it feasible to store massive quantities of minimally processed machine data for later retrieval and analysis. In general, storing minimally processed machine data and performing analysis operations at search time can provide greater flexibility because it enables an analyst to search all of the machine data, instead of searching only a pre-specified set of data items. This may enable an analyst to investigate different aspects of the machine data that previously were unavailable for analysis.
However, analyzing and searching massive quantities of machine data presents a number of challenges. For example, a data center, servers, or network appliances may generate many different types and formats of machine data (e.g., system logs, network packet data (e.g., wire data, etc.), sensor data, application program data, error logs, stack traces, system performance data, operating system data, virtualization data, etc.) from thousands of different components, which can collectively be very time-consuming to analyze. In another example, mobile devices may generate large amounts of information relating to data accesses, application performance, operating system performance, network performance, etc. There can be millions of mobile devices that report these types of information.
These challenges can be addressed by using an event-based data intake and query system, such as the SPLUNK® ENTERPRISE system developed by Splunk Inc. of San Francisco, Calif. The SPLUNK® ENTERPRISE system is the leading platform for providing real-time operational intelligence that enables organizations to collect, index, and search machine data from various websites, applications, servers, networks, and mobile devices that power their businesses. The data intake and query system is particularly useful for analyzing data which is commonly found in system log files, network data, and other data input sources. Although many of the techniques described herein are explained with reference to a data intake and query system similar to the SPLUNK® ENTERPRISE system, these techniques are also applicable to other types of data systems.
In the data intake and query system, machine data are collected and stored as “events.” An event comprises a portion of machine data and is associated with a specific point in time. The portion of machine data may reflect activity in an IT environment and may be produced by a component of that IT environment, where the events may be searched to provide insight into the IT environment, thereby improving the performance of components in the IT environment. Events may be derived from “time series data,” where the time series data comprises a sequence of data points (e.g., performance measurements from a computer system, etc.) that are associated with successive points in time. In general, each event has a portion of machine data that is associated with a timestamp that is derived from the portion of machine data in the event. A timestamp of an event may be determined through interpolation between temporally proximate events having known timestamps or may be determined based on other configurable rules for associating timestamps with events.
In some instances, machine data can have a predefined format, where data items with specific data formats are stored at predefined locations in the data. For example, the machine data may include data associated with fields in a database table. In other instances, machine data may not have a predefined format (e.g., may not be at fixed, predefined locations), but may have repeatable (e.g., non-random) patterns. This means that some machine data can comprise various data items of different data types that may be stored at different locations within the data. For example, when the data source is an operating system log, an event can include one or more lines from the operating system log containing machine data that includes different types of performance and diagnostic information associated with a specific point in time (e.g., a timestamp).
Examples of components which may generate machine data from which events can be derived include, but are not limited to, web servers, application servers, databases, firewalls, routers, operating systems, and software applications that execute on computer systems, mobile devices, sensors, Internet of Things (IoT) devices, etc. The machine data generated by such data sources can include, for example and without limitation, server log files, activity log files, configuration files, messages, network packet data, performance measurements, sensor measurements, etc.
The data intake and query system uses a flexible schema to specify how to extract information from events. A flexible schema may be developed and redefined as needed. Note that a flexible schema may be applied to events “on the fly,” when it is needed (e.g., at search time, index time, ingestion time, etc.). When the schema is not applied to events until search time, the schema may be referred to as a “late-binding schema.”
During operation, the data intake and query system receives machine data from any type and number of sources (e.g., one or more system logs, streams of network packet data, sensor data, application program data, error logs, stack traces, system performance data, etc.). The system parses the machine data to produce events each having a portion of machine data associated with a timestamp. The system stores the events in a data store. The system enables users to run queries against the stored events to, for example, retrieve events that meet criteria specified in a query, such as criteria indicating certain keywords or having specific values in defined fields. As used herein, the term “field” refers to a location in the machine data of an event containing one or more values for a specific data item. A field may be referenced by a field name associated with the field. As will be described in more detail herein, a field is defined by an extraction rule (e.g., a regular expression) that derives one or more values or a sub-portion of text from the portion of machine data in each event to produce a value for the field for that event. The set of values produced are semantically-related (such as IP address), even though the machine data in each event may be in different formats (e.g., semantically-related values may be in different positions in the events derived from different sources).
As described above, the system stores the events in a data store. The events stored in the data store are field-searchable, where field-searchable herein refers to the ability to search the machine data (e.g., the raw machine data) of an event based on a field specified in search criteria. For example, a search having criteria that specifies a field name “UserID” may cause the system to field-search the machine data of events to identify events that have the field name “UserID.” In another example, a search having criteria that specifies a field name “UserID” with a corresponding field value “12345” may cause the system to field-search the machine data of events to identify events having that field-value pair (e.g., field name “UserID” with a corresponding field value of “12345”). Events are field-searchable using one or more configuration files associated with the events. Each configuration file includes one or more field names, where each field name is associated with a corresponding extraction rule and a set of events to which that extraction rule applies. The set of events to which an extraction rule applies may be identified by metadata associated with the set of events. For example, an extraction rule may apply to a set of events that are each associated with a particular host, source, or source type. When events are to be searched based on a particular field name specified in a search, the system uses one or more configuration files to determine whether there is an extraction rule for that particular field name that applies to each event that falls within the criteria of the search. If so, the event is considered as part of the search results (and additional processing may be performed on that event based on criteria specified in the search). If not, the next event is similarly analyzed, and so on.
As noted above, the data intake and query system utilizes a late-binding schema while performing queries on events. One aspect of a late-binding schema is applying extraction rules to events to extract values for specific fields during search time. More specifically, the extraction rule for a field can include one or more instructions that specify how to extract a value for the field from an event. An extraction rule can generally include any type of instruction for extracting values from events. In some cases, an extraction rule comprises a regular expression, where a sequence of characters form a search pattern. An extraction rule comprising a regular expression is referred to herein as a regex rule. The system applies a regex rule to an event to extract values for a field associated with the regex rule, where the values are extracted by searching the event for the sequence of characters defined in the regex rule.
In the data intake and query system, a field extractor may be configured to automatically generate extraction rules for certain fields in the events when the events are being created, indexed, or stored, or possibly at a later time. Alternatively, a user may manually define extraction rules for fields using a variety of techniques. In contrast to a conventional schema for a database system, a late-binding schema is not defined at data ingestion time. Instead, the late-binding schema can be developed on an ongoing basis until the time a query is actually executed. This means that extraction rules for the fields specified in a query may be provided in the query itself, or may be located during execution of the query. Hence, as a user learns more about the data in the events, the user can continue to refine the late-binding schema by adding new fields, deleting fields, or modifying the field extraction rules for use the next time the schema is used by the system. Because the data intake and query system maintains the underlying machine data and uses a late-binding schema for searching the machine data, it enables a user to continue investigating and learn valuable insights about the machine data.
In some embodiments, a common field name may be used to reference two or more fields containing equivalent and/or similar data items, even though the fields may be associated with different types of events that possibly have different data formats and different extraction rules. By enabling a common field name to be used to identify equivalent and/or similar fields from different types of events generated by disparate data sources, the system facilitates use of a “common information model” (CIM) across the disparate data sources (further discussed with respect to
The networked computer system 100 comprises one or more computing devices. These one or more computing devices comprise any combination of hardware and software configured to implement the various logical components described herein. For example, the one or more computing devices may include one or more memories that store instructions for implementing the various components described herein, one or more hardware processors configured to execute the instructions stored in the one or more memories, and various data repositories in the one or more memories for storing data structures utilized and manipulated by the various components.
In some embodiments, one or more client devices 102 are coupled to one or more host devices 106 and a data intake and query system 108 via one or more networks 104. Networks 104 broadly represent one or more LANs, WANs, cellular networks (e.g., LTE, HSPA, 3G, and other cellular technologies), and/or networks using any of wired, wireless, terrestrial microwave, or satellite links, and may include the public Internet.
2.1. Host Devices
In the illustrated embodiment, a system 100 includes one or more host devices 106. Host devices 106 may broadly include any number of computers, virtual machine instances, and/or data centers that are configured to host or execute one or more instances of host applications 114. In general, a host device 106 may be involved, directly or indirectly, in processing requests received from client devices 102. Each host device 106 may comprise, for example, one or more of a network device, a web server, an application server, a database server, etc. A collection of host devices 106 may be configured to implement a network-based service. For example, a provider of a network-based service may configure one or more host devices 106 and host applications 114 (e.g., one or more web servers, application servers, database servers, etc.) to collectively implement the network-based application.
In general, client devices 102 communicate with one or more host applications 114 to exchange information. The communication between a client device 102 and a host application 114 may, for example, be based on the Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) or any other network protocol. Content delivered from the host application 114 to a client device 102 may include, for example, HTML documents, media content, etc. The communication between a client device 102 and host application 114 may include sending various requests and receiving data packets. For example, in general, a client device 102 or application running on a client device may initiate communication with a host application 114 by making a request for a specific resource (e.g., based on an HTTP request), and the application server may respond with the requested content stored in one or more response packets.
In the illustrated embodiment, one or more of host applications 114 may generate various types of performance data during operation, including event logs, network data, sensor data, and other types of machine data. For example, a host application 114 comprising a web server may generate one or more web server logs in which details of interactions between the web server and any number of client devices 102 is recorded. As another example, a host device 106 comprising a router may generate one or more router logs that record information related to network traffic managed by the router. As yet another example, a host application 114 comprising a database server may generate one or more logs that record information related to requests sent from other host applications 114 (e.g., web servers or application servers) for data managed by the database server.
2.2. Client Devices
Client devices 102 of
2.3. Client Device Applications
In some embodiments, each client device 102 may host or execute one or more client applications 110 that are capable of interacting with one or more host devices 106 via one or more networks 104. For instance, a client application 110 may be or comprise a web browser that a user may use to navigate to one or more websites or other resources provided by one or more host devices 106. As another example, a client application 110 may comprise a mobile application or “app.” For example, an operator of a network-based service hosted by one or more host devices 106 may make available one or more mobile apps that enable users of client devices 102 to access various resources of the network-based service. As yet another example, client applications 110 may include background processes that perform various operations without direct interaction from a user. A client application 110 may include a “plug-in” or “extension” to another application, such as a web browser plug-in or extension.
In some embodiments, a client application 110 may include a monitoring component 112. At a high level, the monitoring component 112 comprises a software component or other logic that facilitates generating performance data related to a client device's operating state, including monitoring network traffic sent and received from the client device and collecting other device and/or application-specific information. Monitoring component 112 may be an integrated component of a client application 110, a plug-in, an extension, or any other type of add-on component. Monitoring component 112 may also be a stand-alone process.
In some embodiments, a monitoring component 112 may be created when a client application 110 is developed, for example, by an application developer using a software development kit (SDK). The SDK may include custom monitoring code that can be incorporated into the code implementing a client application 110. When the code is converted to an executable application, the custom code implementing the monitoring functionality can become part of the application itself.
In some embodiments, an SDK or other code for implementing the monitoring functionality may be offered by a provider of a data intake and query system, such as a system 108. In such cases, the provider of the system 108 can implement the custom code so that performance data generated by the monitoring functionality is sent to the system 108 to facilitate analysis of the performance data by a developer of the client application or other users.
In some embodiments, the custom monitoring code may be incorporated into the code of a client application 110 in a number of different ways, such as the insertion of one or more lines in the client application code that call or otherwise invoke the monitoring component 112. As such, a developer of a client application 110 can add one or more lines of code into the client application 110 to trigger the monitoring component 112 at desired points during execution of the application. Code that triggers the monitoring component may be referred to as a monitor trigger. For instance, a monitor trigger may be included at or near the beginning of the executable code of the client application 110 such that the monitoring component 112 is initiated or triggered as the application is launched, or included at other points in the code that correspond to various actions of the client application, such as sending a network request or displaying a particular interface.
In some embodiments, the monitoring component 112 may monitor one or more aspects of network traffic sent and/or received by a client application 110. For example, the monitoring component 112 may be configured to monitor data packets transmitted to and/or from one or more host applications 114. Incoming and/or outgoing data packets can be read or examined to identify network data contained within the packets, for example, and other aspects of data packets can be analyzed to determine a number of network performance statistics. Monitoring network traffic may enable information to be gathered particular to the network performance associated with a client application 110 or set of applications.
In some embodiments, network performance data refers to any type of data that indicates information about the network and/or network performance. Network performance data may include, for instance, a URL requested, a connection type (e.g., HTTP, HTTPS, etc.), a connection start time, a connection end time, an HTTP status code, request length, response length, request headers, response headers, connection status (e.g., completion, response time(s), failure, etc.), and the like. Upon obtaining network performance data indicating performance of the network, the network performance data can be transmitted to a data intake and query system 108 for analysis.
Upon developing a client application 110 that incorporates a monitoring component 112, the client application 110 can be distributed to client devices 102. Applications generally can be distributed to client devices 102 in any manner, or they can be pre-loaded. In some cases, the application may be distributed to a client device 102 via an application marketplace or other application distribution system. For instance, an application marketplace or other application distribution system might distribute the application to a client device based on a request from the client device to download the application.
Examples of functionality that enables monitoring performance of a client device are described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/524,748, entitled “UTILIZING PACKET HEADERS TO MONITOR NETWORK TRAFFIC IN ASSOCIATION WITH A CLIENT DEVICE”, filed on 27 Oct. 2014, and which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety for all purposes.
In some embodiments, the monitoring component 112 may also monitor and collect performance data related to one or more aspects of the operational state of a client application 110 and/or client device 102. For example, a monitoring component 112 may be configured to collect device performance information by monitoring one or more client device operations, or by making calls to an operating system and/or one or more other applications executing on a client device 102 for performance information. Device performance information may include, for instance, a current wireless signal strength of the device, a current connection type and network carrier, current memory performance information, a geographic location of the device, a device orientation, and any other information related to the operational state of the client device.
In some embodiments, the monitoring component 112 may also monitor and collect other device profile information including, for example, a type of client device, a manufacturer, and model of the device, versions of various software applications installed on the device, and so forth.
In general, a monitoring component 112 may be configured to generate performance data in response to a monitor trigger in the code of a client application 110 or other triggering application event, as described above, and to store the performance data in one or more data records. Each data record, for example, may include a collection of field-value pairs, each field-value pair storing a particular item of performance data in association with a field for the item. For example, a data record generated by a monitoring component 112 may include a “networkLatency” field (not shown in the Figure) in which a value is stored. This field indicates a network latency measurement associated with one or more network requests. The data record may include a “state” field to store a value indicating a state of a network connection, and so forth for any number of aspects of collected performance data.
2.4. Data Intake and Query System Overview
The data intake and query system 108 can process and store data received data from the data sources client devices 102 or host devices 106, and execute queries on the data in response to requests received from one or more computing devices. In some cases, the data intake and query system 108 can generate events from the received data and store the events in buckets in a common storage system. In response to received queries, the data intake and query system can assign one or more search nodes to search the buckets in the common storage.
In certain embodiments, the data intake and query system 108 can include various components that enable it to provide stateless services or enable it to recover from an unavailable or unresponsive component without data loss in a time efficient manner. For example, the data intake and query system 108 can store contextual information about its various components in a distributed way such that if one of the components becomes unresponsive or unavailable, the data intake and query system 108 can replace the unavailable component with a different component and provide the replacement component with the contextual information. In this way, the data intake and query system 108 can quickly recover from an unresponsive or unavailable component while reducing or eliminating the loss of data that was being processed by the unavailable component.
Each data source 202 broadly represents a distinct source of data that can be consumed by the data intake and query system 108. Examples of data sources 202 include, without limitation, data files, directories of files, data sent over a network, event logs, registries, streaming data services (examples of which can include, by way of non-limiting example, Amazon's Simple Queue Service (“SQS”) or Kinesis™ services, devices executing Apache Kafka™ software, or devices implementing the Message Queue Telemetry Transport (MQTT) protocol, Microsoft Azure EventHub, Google Cloud Pub Sub, devices implementing the Java Message Service (JMS) protocol, devices implementing the Advanced Message Queuing Protocol (AMQP)), performance metrics, etc.
The client devices 204 can be implemented using one or more computing devices in communication with the data intake and query system 108, and represent some of the different ways in which computing devices can submit queries to the data intake and query system 108. For example, the client device 204a is illustrated as communicating over an Internet (Web) protocol with the data intake and query system 108, the client device 204b is illustrated as communicating with the data intake and query system 108 via a command line interface, and the client device 204b is illustrated as communicating with the data intake and query system 108 via a software developer kit (SDK). However, it will be understood that the client devices 204 can communicate with and submit queries to the data intake and query system 108 in a variety of ways.
The data intake and query system 108 can process and store data received data from the data sources 202 and execute queries on the data in response to requests received from the client devices 204. In the illustrated embodiment, the data intake and query system 108 includes an intake system 210, an indexing system 212, a query system 214, common storage 216 including one or more data stores 218, a data store catalog 220, and a query acceleration data store 222.
As mentioned, the data intake and query system 108 can receive data from different sources 202. In some cases, the data sources 202 can be associated with different tenants or customers. Further, each tenant may be associated with one or more indexes, hosts, sources, sourcetypes, or users. For example, company ABC, Inc. can correspond to one tenant and company XYZ, Inc. can correspond to a different tenant. While the two companies may be unrelated, each company may have a main index and test index associated with it, as well as one or more data sources or systems (e.g., billing system, CRM system, etc.). The data intake and query system 108 can concurrently receive and process the data from the various systems and sources of ABC, Inc. and XYZ, Inc.
In certain cases, although the data from different tenants can be processed together or concurrently, the data intake and query system 108 can take steps to avoid combining or co-mingling data from the different tenants. For example, the data intake and query system 108 can assign a tenant identifier for each tenant and maintain a separation between the data using the tenant identifier. In some cases, the tenant identifier can be assigned to the data at the data sources 202, or can be assigned to the data by the data intake and query system 108 at ingest.
As will be described in greater detail herein, at least with reference to
As will be described in greater detail herein, at least with reference to
As will be described in greater detail herein, at least with reference to
As mentioned and as will be described in greater detail below, the common storage 216 can be made up of one or more data stores 218 storing data that has been processed by the indexing system 212. The common storage 216 can be configured to provide high availability, highly resilient, low loss data storage. In some cases, to provide the high availability, highly resilient, low loss data storage, the common storage 216 can store multiple copies of the data in the same and different geographic locations and across different types of data stores (e.g., solid state, hard drive, tape, etc.). Further, as data is received at the common storage 216 it can be automatically replicated multiple times according to a replication factor to different data stores across the same and/or different geographic locations. In some embodiments, the common storage 216 can correspond to cloud storage, such as Amazon Simple Storage Service (S3) or Elastic Block Storage (EBS), Google Cloud Storage, Microsoft Azure Storage, etc.
In some embodiments, indexing system 212 can read to and write from the common storage 216. For example, the indexing system 212 can copy buckets of data from its local or shared data stores to the common storage 216. In certain embodiments, the query system 214 can read from, but cannot write to, the common storage 216. For example, the query system 214 can read the buckets of data stored in common storage 216 by the indexing system 212, but may not be able to copy buckets or other data to the common storage 216. In some embodiments, the intake system 210 does not have access to the common storage 216. However, in some embodiments, one or more components of the intake system 210 can write data to the common storage 216 that can be read by the indexing system 212.
As described herein, such as with reference to
The data store catalog 220 can store information about the data stored in common storage 216, such as, but not limited to an identifier for a set of data or buckets, a location of the set of data, tenants or indexes associated with the set of data, timing information about the data, etc. For example, in embodiments where the data in common storage 216 is stored as buckets, the data store catalog 220 can include a bucket identifier for the buckets in common storage 216, a location of or path to the bucket in common storage 216, a time range of the data in the bucket (e.g., range of time between the first-in-time event of the bucket and the last-in-time event of the bucket), a tenant identifier identifying a customer or computing device associated with the bucket, and/or an index (also referred to herein as a partition) associated with the bucket, etc. In certain embodiments, the data intake and query system 108 includes multiple data store catalogs 220. For example, in some embodiments, the data intake and query system 108 can include a data store catalog 220 for each tenant (or group of tenants), each partition of each tenant (or group of indexes), etc. In some cases, the data intake and query system 108 can include a single data store catalog 220 that includes information about buckets associated with multiple or all of the tenants associated with the data intake and query system 108.
The indexing system 212 can update the data store catalog 220 as the indexing system 212 stores data in common storage 216. Furthermore, the indexing system 212 or other computing device associated with the data store catalog 220 can update the data store catalog 220 as the information in the common storage 216 changes (e.g., as buckets in common storage 216 are merged, deleted, etc.). In addition, as described herein, the query system 214 can use the data store catalog 220 to identify data to be searched or data that satisfies at least a portion of a query. In some embodiments, the query system 214 makes requests to and receives data from the data store catalog 220 using an application programming interface (“API”).
The query acceleration data store 222 can store the results or partial results of queries, or otherwise be used to accelerate queries. For example, if a user submits a query that has no end date, the system can query system 214 can store an initial set of results in the query acceleration data store 222. As additional query results are determined based on additional data, the additional results can be combined with the initial set of results, and so on. In this way, the query system 214 can avoid re-searching all of the data that may be responsive to the query and instead search the data that has not already been searched.
In some environments, a user of a data intake and query system 108 may install and configure, on computing devices owned and operated by the user, one or more software applications that implement some or all of these system components. For example, a user may install a software application on server computers owned by the user and configure each server to operate as one or more of intake system 210, indexing system 212, query system 214, common storage 216, data store catalog 220, or query acceleration data store 222, etc. This arrangement generally may be referred to as an “on-premises” solution. That is, the system 108 is installed and operates on computing devices directly controlled by the user of the system. Some users may prefer an on-premises solution because it may provide a greater level of control over the configuration of certain aspects of the system (e.g., security, privacy, standards, controls, etc.). However, other users may instead prefer an arrangement in which the user is not directly responsible for providing and managing the computing devices upon which various components of system 108 operate.
In certain embodiments, one or more of the components of a data intake and query system 108 can be implemented in a remote distributed computing system. In this context, a remote distributed computing system or cloud-based service can refer to a service hosted by one more computing resources that are accessible to end users over a network, for example, by using a web browser or other application on a client device to interface with the remote computing resources. For example, a service provider may provide a data intake and query system 108 by managing computing resources configured to implement various aspects of the system (e.g., intake system 210, indexing system 212, query system 214, common storage 216, data store catalog 220, or query acceleration data store 222, etc.) and by providing access to the system to end users via a network. Typically, a user may pay a subscription or other fee to use such a service. Each subscribing user of the cloud-based service may be provided with an account that enables the user to configure a customized cloud-based system based on the user's preferences. When implemented as a cloud-based service, various components of the system 108 can be implemented using containerization or operating-system-level virtualization, or other virtualization technique. For example, one or more components of the intake system 210, indexing system 212, or query system 214 can be implemented as separate software containers or container instances. Each container instance can have certain resources (e.g., memory, processor, etc.) of the underlying host computing system assigned to it, but may share the same operating system and may use the operating system's system call interface. Each container may provide an isolated execution environment on the host system, such as by providing a memory space of the host system that is logically isolated from memory space of other containers. Further, each container may run the same or different computer applications concurrently or separately, and may interact with each other. Although reference is made herein to containerization and container instances, it will be understood that other virtualization techniques can be used. For example, the components can be implemented using virtual machines using full virtualization or paravirtualization, etc. Thus, where reference is made to “containerized” components, it should be understood that such components may additionally or alternatively be implemented in other isolated execution environments, such as a virtual machine environment.
3.1. Intake System
As detailed below, data may be ingested at the data intake and query system 108 through an intake system 210 configured to conduct preliminary processing on the data, and make the data available to downstream systems or components, such as the indexing system 212, query system 214, third party systems, etc.
One example configuration of an intake system 210 is shown in
Although shown as separate components, the forwarder 302, data retrieval subsystem 304, intake ingestion buffer 306, streaming data processors 308, and output ingestion buffer 310, in various embodiments, may reside on the same machine or be distributed across multiple machines in any combination. In one embodiment, any or all of the components of the intake system can be implemented using one or more computing devices as distinct computing devices or as one or more container instances or virtual machines across one or more computing devices. It will be appreciated by those skilled in the art that the intake system 210 may have more of fewer components than are illustrated in
In some embodiments, some or all of the elements of the intake system 210 (e.g., forwarder 302, data retrieval subsystem 304, intake ingestion buffer 306, streaming data processors 308, and output ingestion buffer 310, etc.) may reside on one or more computing devices, such as servers, which may be communicatively coupled with each other and with the data sources 202, query system 214, indexing system 212, or other components. In other embodiments, some or all of the elements of the intake system 210 may be implemented as worker nodes as disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. Nos. 15/665,159, 15/665,148, 15/665,187, 15/665,248, 15/665,197, 15/665,279, 15/665,302, and 15/665,339, each of which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety (hereinafter referred to as “the Parent Applications”).
As noted above, the intake system 210 can function to conduct preliminary processing of data ingested at the data intake and query system 108. As such, the intake system 210 illustratively includes a forwarder 302 that obtains data from a data source 202 and transmits the data to a data retrieval subsystem 304. The data retrieval subsystem 304 may be configured to convert or otherwise format data provided by the forwarder 302 into an appropriate format for inclusion at the intake ingestion buffer and transmit the message to the intake ingestion buffer 306 for processing. Thereafter, a streaming data processor 308 may obtain data from the intake ingestion buffer 306, process the data according to one or more rules, and republish the data to either the intake ingestion buffer 306 (e.g., for additional processing) or to the output ingestion buffer 310, such that the data is made available to downstream components or systems. In this manner, the intake system 210 may repeatedly or iteratively process data according to any of a variety of rules, such that the data is formatted for use on the data intake and query system 108 or any other system. As discussed below, the intake system 210 may be configured to conduct such processing rapidly (e.g., in “real-time” with little or no perceptible delay), while ensuring resiliency of the data.
3.1.1. Forwarder
The forwarder 302 can include or be executed on a computing device configured to obtain data from a data source 202 and transmit the data to the data retrieval subsystem 304. In some implementations the forwarder 302 can be installed on a computing device associated with the data source 202. While a single forwarder 302 is illustratively shown in
In some embodiments, a forwarder 302 may comprise a service accessible to data sources 202 via a network 206. For example, one type of forwarder 302 may be capable of consuming vast amounts of real-time data from a potentially large number of data sources 202. The forwarder 302 may, for example, comprise a computing device which implements multiple data pipelines or “queues” to handle forwarding of network data to data retrieval subsystems 304.
3.1.2. Data Retrieval Subsystem
The data retrieval subsystem 304 illustratively corresponds to a computing device which obtains data (e.g., from the forwarder 302), and transforms the data into a format suitable for publication on the intake ingestion buffer 306. Illustratively, where the forwarder 302 segments input data into discrete blocks, the data retrieval subsystem 304 may generate a message for each block, and publish the message to the intake ingestion buffer 306. Generation of a message for each block may include, for example, formatting the data of the message in accordance with the requirements of a streaming data system implementing the intake ingestion buffer 306, the requirements of which may vary according to the streaming data system. In one embodiment, the intake ingestion buffer 306 formats messages according to the protocol buffers method of serializing structured data. Thus, the intake ingestion buffer 306 may be configured to convert data from an input format into a protocol buffer format. Where a forwarder 302 does not segment input data into discrete blocks, the data retrieval subsystem 304 may itself segment the data. Similarly, the data retrieval subsystem 304 may append metadata to the input data, such as a source, source type, or host associated with the data.
Generation of the message may include “tagging” the message with various information, which may be included as metadata for the data provided by the forwarder 302, and determining a “topic” for the message, under which the message should be published to the intake ingestion buffer 306. In general, the “topic” of a message may reflect a categorization of the message on a streaming data system. Illustratively, each topic may be associated with a logically distinct queue of messages, such that a downstream device or system may “subscribe” to the topic in order to be provided with messages published to the topic on the streaming data system.
In one embodiment, the data retrieval subsystem 304 may obtain a set of topic rules (e.g., provided by a user of the data intake and query system 108 or based on automatic inspection or identification of the various upstream and downstream components of the data intake and query system 108) that determine a topic for a message as a function of the received data or metadata regarding the received data. For example, the topic of a message may be determined as a function of the data source 202 from which the data stems. After generation of a message based on input data, the data retrieval subsystem can publish the message to the intake ingestion buffer 306 under the determined topic.
While the data retrieval and subsystem 304 is depicted in
One illustrative set of intake points implementing the data retrieval and subsystem 304 is shown in
As shown in
In addition to the push-based publishers 320, one or more pull-based publishers 330 may be used to implement the data retrieval subsystem 304. The pull-based publishers 330 may function on a “pull” model, whereby a data target (e.g., the primary intake ingestion buffer 306A) functions to continuously or periodically (e.g., each n seconds) query the pull-based publishers 330 for new messages to be placed on the primary intake ingestion buffer 306A. In some instances, development of pull-based systems may require less coordination of functionality between a pull-based publisher 330 and the primary intake ingestion buffer 306A. Thus, for example, pull-based publishers 330 may be more readily developed by third parties (e.g., other than a developer of the data intake a query system 108), and enable the data intake and query system 108 to ingest data associated with third party data sources 202. Accordingly,
While the pull-based publishers 330 are illustratively described as developed by third parties, push-based publishers 320 may also in some instances be developed by third parties. Additionally or alternatively, pull-based publishers may be developed by the developer of the data intake and query system 108. To facilitate integration of systems potentially developed by disparate entities, the primary intake ingestion buffer 306A may provide an API through which an intake point may publish messages to the primary intake ingestion buffer 306A. Illustratively, the API may enable an intake point to “push” messages to the primary intake ingestion buffer 306A, or request that the primary intake ingestion buffer 306A “pull” messages from the intake point. Similarly, the streaming data processors 308 may provide an API through which ingestions buffers may register with the streaming data processors 308 to facilitate pre-processing of messages on the ingestion buffers, and the output ingestion buffer 310 may provide an API through which the streaming data processors 308 may publish messages or through which downstream devices or systems may subscribe to topics on the output ingestion buffer 310. Furthermore, any one or more of the intake points 322 through 332N may provide an API through which data sources 202 may submit data to the intake points. Thus, any one or more of the components of
The specific configuration of publishers 320 and 330 shown in
3.1.3. Ingestion Buffer
The intake system 210 is illustratively configured to ensure message resiliency, such that data is persisted in the event of failures within the intake system 210. Specifically, the intake system 210 may utilize one or more ingestion buffers, which operate to resiliently maintain data received at the intake system 210 until the data is acknowledged by downstream systems or components. In one embodiment, resiliency is provided at the intake system 210 by use of ingestion buffers that operate according to a publish-subscribe (“pub-sub”) message model. In accordance with the pub-sub model, data ingested into the data intake and query system 108 may be atomized as “messages,” each of which is categorized into one or more “topics.” An ingestion buffer can maintain a queue for each such topic, and enable devices to “subscribe” to a given topic. As messages are published to the topic, the ingestion buffer can function to transmit the messages to each subscriber, and ensure message resiliency until at least each subscriber has acknowledged receipt of the message (e.g., at which point the ingestion buffer may delete the message). In this manner, the ingestion buffer may function as a “broker” within the pub-sub model. A variety of techniques to ensure resiliency at a pub-sub broker are known in the art, and thus will not be described in detail herein. In one embodiment, an ingestion buffer is implemented by a streaming data source. As noted above, examples of streaming data sources include (but are not limited to) Amazon's Simple Queue Service (“SQS”) or Kinesis™ services, devices executing Apache Kafka™ software, or devices implementing the Message Queue Telemetry Transport (MQTT) protocol. Any one or more of these example streaming data sources may be utilized to implement an ingestion buffer in accordance with embodiments of the present disclosure.
With reference to
Both the input ingestion buffer 306 and output ingestion buffer 310 may be implemented on a streaming data source, as noted above. In one embodiment, the intake ingestion buffer 306 operates to maintain source-oriented topics, such as topics for each data source 202 from which data is obtained, while the output ingestion buffer operates to maintain content-oriented topics, such as topics to which the data of an individual message pertains. As discussed in more detail below, the streaming data processors 308 can be configured to transform messages from the intake ingestion buffer 306 (e.g., arranged according to source-oriented topics) and publish the transformed messages to the output ingestion buffer 310 (e.g., arranged according to content-oriented topics). In some instances, the streaming data processors 308 may additionally or alternatively republish transformed messages to the intake ingestion buffer 306, enabling iterative or repeated processing of the data within the message by the streaming data processors 308.
While shown in
Moreover, either or both of the ingestion buffers 306 and 310 may be implemented across multiple distinct devices, as either a single or multiple ingestion buffers. Illustratively, as shown in
As noted above, an intake ingestion buffer 306 may in some embodiments categorize messages according to source-oriented topics (e.g., denoting a data source 202 from which the message was obtained). In other embodiments, an intake ingestion buffer 306 may in some embodiments categorize messages according to intake-oriented topics (e.g., denoting the intake point from which the message was obtained). The number and variety of such topics may vary, and thus are not shown in
The output ingestion buffer 310 may in one embodiment categorize messages according to content-centric topics (e.g., determined based on the content of a message). Additionally or alternatively, the output ingestion buffer 310 may categorize messages according to consumer-centric topics (e.g., topics intended to store messages for consumption by a downstream device or system). An illustrative number of topics are shown in
As will be described below, by application of message transformation rules at the streaming data processors 308, the intake system 210 may divide and categorize messages from the intake ingestion buffer 306, partitioning the message into output topics relevant to a specific downstream consumer. In this manner, specific portions of data input to the data intake and query system 108 may be “divided out” and handled separately, enabling different types of data to be handled differently, and potentially at different speeds. Illustratively, the index topic 342 may be configured to include all or substantially all data included in the intake ingestion buffer 306. Given the volume of data, there may be a significant delay (e.g., minutes or hours) before a downstream consumer (e.g., the indexing system 212) processes a message in the index topic 342. Thus, for example, searching data processed by the indexing system 212 may incur significant delay.
Conversely, the search results topic 348 may be configured to hold only messages corresponding to data relevant to a current query. Illustratively, on receiving a query from a client device 204, the query system 214 may transmit to the intake system 210 a rule that detects, within messages from the intake ingestion buffer 306A, data potentially relevant to the query. The streaming data processors 308 may republish these messages within the search results topic 348, and the query system 214 may subscribe to the search results topic 348 in order to obtain the data within the messages. In this manner, the query system 214 can “bypass” the indexing system 212 and avoid delay that may be caused by that system, thus enabling faster (and potentially real time) display of search results.
While shown in
3.1.4. Streaming Data Processors
As noted above, the streaming data processors 308 may apply one or more rules to process messages from the intake ingestion buffer 306A into messages on the output ingestion buffer 310. These rules may be specified, for example, by an end user of the data intake and query system 108 or may be automatically generated by the data intake and query system 108 (e.g., in response to a user query).
Illustratively, each rule may correspond to a set of selection criteria indicating messages to which the rule applies, as well as one or more processing sub-rules indicating an action to be taken by the streaming data processors 308 with respect to the message. The selection criteria may include any number or combination of criteria based on the data included within a message or metadata of the message (e.g., a topic to which the message is published). In one embodiment, the selection criteria are formatted in the same manner or similarly to extraction rules, discussed in more detail below. For example, selection criteria may include regular expressions that derive one or more values or a sub-portion of text from the portion of machine data in each message to produce a value for the field for that message. When a message is located within the intake ingestion buffer 306 that matches the selection criteria, the streaming data processors 308 may apply the processing rules to the message. Processing sub-rules may indicate, for example, a topic of the output ingestion buffer 310 into which the message should be placed. Processing sub-rules may further indicate transformations, such as field or unit normalization operations, to be performed on the message. Illustratively, a transformation may include modifying data within the message, such as altering a format in which the data is conveyed (e.g., converting millisecond timestamps values to microsecond timestamp values, converting imperial units to metric units, etc.), or supplementing the data with additional information (e.g., appending an error descriptor to an error code). In some instances, the streaming data processors 308 may be in communication with one or more external data stores (the locations of which may be specified within a rule) that provide information used to supplement or enrich messages processed at the streaming data processors 308. For example, a specific rule may include selection criteria identifying an error code within a message of the primary ingestion buffer 306A, and specifying that when the error code is detected within a message, that the streaming data processors 308 should conduct a lookup in an external data source (e.g., a database) to retrieve the human-readable descriptor for that error code, and inject the descriptor into the message. In this manner, rules may be used to process, transform, or enrich messages.
The streaming data processors 308 may include a set of computing devices configured to process messages from the intake ingestion buffer 306 at a speed commensurate with a rate at which messages are placed into the intake ingestion buffer 306. In one embodiment, the number of streaming data processors 308 used to process messages may vary based on a number of messages on the intake ingestion buffer 306 awaiting processing. Thus, as additional messages are queued into the intake ingestion buffer 306, the number of streaming data processors 308 may be increased to ensure that such messages are rapidly processed. In some instances, the streaming data processors 308 may be extensible on a per topic basis. Thus, individual devices implementing the streaming data processors 308 may subscribe to different topics on the intake ingestion buffer 306, and the number of devices subscribed to an individual topic may vary according to a rate of publication of messages to that topic (e.g., as measured by a backlog of messages in the topic). In this way, the intake system 210 can support ingestion of massive amounts of data from numerous data sources 202.
In some embodiments, an intake system may comprise a service accessible to client devices 102 and host devices 106 via a network 104. For example, one type of forwarder may be capable of consuming vast amounts of real-time data from a potentially large number of client devices 102 and/or host devices 106. The forwarder may, for example, comprise a computing device which implements multiple data pipelines or “queues” to handle forwarding of network data to indexers. A forwarder may also perform many of the functions that are performed by an indexer. For example, a forwarder may perform keyword extractions on raw data or parse raw data to create events. A forwarder may generate time stamps for events. Additionally or alternatively, a forwarder may perform routing of events to indexers. Data store 212 may contain events derived from machine data from a variety of sources all pertaining to the same component in an IT environment, and this data may be produced by the machine in question or by other components in the IT environment.
3.2. Indexing System
In the illustrated embodiment, the indexing system 212 includes an indexing system manager 402 and one or more indexing nodes 404. However, it will be understood that the indexing system 212 can include fewer or more components. For example, in some embodiments, the common storage 216 or data store catalog 220 can form part of the indexing system 212, etc.
As described herein, each of the components of the indexing system 212 can be implemented using one or more computing devices as distinct computing devices or as one or more container instances or virtual machines across one or more computing devices. For example, in some embodiments, the indexing system manager 402 and indexing nodes 404 can be implemented as distinct computing devices with separate hardware, memory, and processors. In certain embodiments, the indexing system manager 402 and indexing nodes 404 can be implemented on the same or across different computing devices as distinct container instances, with each container having access to a subset of the resources of a host computing device (e.g., a subset of the memory or processing time of the processors of the host computing device), but sharing a similar operating system. In some cases, the components can be implemented as distinct virtual machines across one or more computing devices, where each virtual machine can have its own unshared operating system but shares the underlying hardware with other virtual machines on the same host computing device.
3.2.1 Indexing System Manager
As mentioned, the indexing system manager 402 can monitor and manage the indexing nodes 404, and can be implemented as a distinct computing device, virtual machine, container, container of a pod, or a process or thread associated with a container. In certain embodiments, the indexing system 212 can include one indexing system manager 402 to manage all indexing nodes 404 of the indexing system 212. In some embodiments, the indexing system 212 can include multiple indexing system managers 402. For example, an indexing system manager 402 can be instantiated for each computing device (or group of computing devices) configured as a host computing device for multiple indexing nodes 404.
The indexing system manager 402 can handle resource management, creation/destruction of indexing nodes 404, high availability, load balancing, application upgrades/rollbacks, logging and monitoring, storage, networking, service discovery, and performance and scalability, and otherwise handle containerization management of the containers of the indexing system 212. In certain embodiments, the indexing system manager 402 can be implemented using Kubernetes or Swarm.
In some cases, the indexing system manager 402 can monitor the available resources of a host computing device and request additional resources in a shared resource environment, based on workload of the indexing nodes 404 or create, destroy, or reassign indexing nodes 404 based on workload. Further, the indexing system manager 402 system can assign indexing nodes 404 to handle data streams based on workload, system resources, etc.
3.2.2. Indexing Nodes
The indexing nodes 404 can include one or more components to implement various functions of the indexing system 212. In the illustrated embodiment, the indexing node 404 includes an indexing node manager 406, partition manager 408, indexer 410, data store 412, and bucket manager 414. As described herein, the indexing nodes 404 can be implemented on separate computing devices or as containers or virtual machines in a virtualization environment.
In some embodiments, an indexing node 404, and can be implemented as a distinct computing device, virtual machine, container, container of a pod, or a process or thread associated with a container, or using multiple-related containers. In certain embodiments, such as in a Kubernetes deployment, each indexing node 404 can be implemented as a separate container or pod. For example, one or more of the components of the indexing node 404 can be implemented as different containers of a single pod, e.g., on a containerization platform, such as Docker, the one or more components of the indexing node can be implemented as different Docker containers managed by synchronization platforms such as Kubernetes or Swarm. Accordingly, reference to a containerized indexing node 404 can refer to the indexing node 404 as being a single container or as one or more components of the indexing node 404 being implemented as different, related containers or virtual machines.
3.2.2.1. Indexing Node Manager
The indexing node manager 406 can manage the processing of the various streams or partitions of data by the indexing node 404, and can be implemented as a distinct computing device, virtual machine, container, container of a pod, or a process or thread associated with a container. For example, in certain embodiments, as partitions or data streams are assigned to the indexing node 404, the indexing node manager 406 can generate one or more partition manager(s) 408 to manage each partition or data stream. In some cases, the indexing node manager 406 generates a separate partition manager 408 for each partition or shard that is processed by the indexing node 404. In certain embodiments, the partition can correspond to a topic of a data stream of the ingestion buffer 310. Each topic can be configured in a variety of ways. For example, in some embodiments, a topic may correspond to data from a particular data source 202, tenant, index/partition, or sourcetype. In this way, in certain embodiments, the indexing system 212 can discriminate between data from different sources or associated with different tenants, or indexes/partitions. For example, the indexing system 212 can assign more indexing nodes 404 to process data from one topic (associated with one tenant) than another topic (associated with another tenant), or store the data from one topic more frequently to common storage 216 than the data from a different topic, etc.
In some embodiments, the indexing node manager 406 monitors the various shards of data being processed by the indexing node 404 and the read pointers or location markers for those shards. In some embodiments, the indexing node manager 406 stores the read pointers or location marker in one or more data stores, such as but not limited to, common storage 216, DynamoDB, S3, or another type of storage system, shared storage system, or networked storage system, etc. As the indexing node 404 processes the data and the markers for the shards are updated by the intake system 210, the indexing node manager 406 can be updated to reflect the changes to the read pointers or location markers. In this way, if a particular partition manager 408 becomes unresponsive or unavailable, the indexing node manager 406 can generate a new partition manager 408 to handle the data stream without losing context of what data is to be read from the intake system 210. Accordingly, in some embodiments, by using the ingestion buffer 310 and tracking the location of the location markers in the shards of the ingestion buffer, the indexing system 212 can aid in providing a stateless indexing service.
In some embodiments, the indexing node manager 406 is implemented as a background process, or daemon, on the indexing node 404 and the partition manager(s) 408 are implemented as threads, copies, or forks of the background process. In some cases, an indexing node manager 406 can copy itself, or fork, to create a partition manager 408 or cause a template process to copy itself, or fork, to create each new partition manager 408, etc. This may be done for multithreading efficiency or for other reasons related to containerization and efficiency of managing indexers 410. In certain embodiments, the indexing node manager 406 generates a new process for each partition manager 408. In some cases, by generating a new process for each partition manager 408, the indexing node manager 408 can support multiple language implementations and be language agnostic. For example, the indexing node manager 408 can generate a process for a partition manager 408 in python and create a second process for a partition manager 408 in golang, etc.
3.2.2.2. Partition Manager
As mentioned, the partition manager(s) 408 can manage the processing of one or more of the partitions or shards of a data stream processed by an indexing node 404 or the indexer 410 of the indexing node 404, and can be implemented as a distinct computing device, virtual machine, container, container of a pod, or a process or thread associated with a container.
In some cases, managing the processing of a partition or shard can include, but it not limited to, communicating data from a particular shard to the indexer 410 for processing, monitoring the indexer 410 and the size of the data being processed by the indexer 410, instructing the indexer 410 to move the data to common storage 216, and reporting the storage of the data to the intake system 210. For a particular shard or partition of data from the intake system 210, the indexing node manager 406 can assign a particular partition manager 408. The partition manager 408 for that partition can receive the data from the intake system 210 and forward or communicate that data to the indexer 410 for processing.
In some embodiments, the partition manager 408 receives data from a pub-sub messaging system, such as the ingestion buffer 310. As described herein, the ingestion buffer 310 can have one or more streams of data and one or more shards or partitions associated with each stream of data. Each stream of data can be separated into shards and/or other partitions or types of organization of data. In certain cases, each shard can include data from multiple tenants, indexes/partition, etc. In some cases, each shard can correspond to data associated with a particular tenant, index/partition, source, sourcetype, etc. Accordingly, the indexing system 212 can include a partition manager 408 for individual tenants, indexes/partitions, sources, sourcetypes, etc. In this way, the indexing system 212 can manage and process the data differently. For example, the indexing system 212 can assign more indexing nodes 404 to process data from one tenant than another tenant, or store buckets associated with one tenant or partition/index more frequently to common storage 216 than buckets associated with a different tenant or partition/index, etc.
Accordingly, in some embodiments, a partition manager 408 receives data from one or more of the shards or partitions of the ingestion buffer 310. The partition manager 408 can forward the data from the shard to the indexer 410 for processing. In some cases, the amount of data coming into a shard may exceed the shard's throughput. For example, 4 MB/s of data may be sent to an ingestion buffer 310 for a particular shard, but the ingestion buffer 310 may be able to process only 2 MB/s of data per shard. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the data in the shard can include a reference to a location in storage where the indexing system 212 can retrieve the data. For example, a reference pointer to data can be placed in the ingestion buffer 310 rather than putting the data itself into the ingestion buffer. The reference pointer can reference a chunk of data that is larger than the throughput of the ingestion buffer 310 for that shard. In this way, the data intake and query system 108 can increase the throughput of individual shards of the ingestion buffer 310. In such embodiments, the partition manager 408 can obtain the reference pointer from the ingestion buffer 310 and retrieve the data from the referenced storage for processing. In some cases, the referenced storage to which reference pointers in the ingestion buffer 310 may point can correspond to the common storage 216 or other cloud or local storage. In some implementations, the chunks of data to which the reference pointers refer may be directed to common storage 216 from intake system 210, e.g., streaming data processor 308 or ingestion buffer 310.
As the indexer 410 processes the data, stores the data in buckets, and generates indexes of the data, the partition manager 408 can monitor the indexer 410 and the size of the data on the indexer 410 (inclusive of the data store 412) associated with the partition. The size of the data on the indexer 410 can correspond to the data that is actually received from the particular partition of the intake system 210, as well as data generated by the indexer 410 based on the received data (e.g., inverted indexes, summaries, etc.), and may correspond to one or more buckets. For instance, the indexer 410 may have generated one or more buckets for each tenant and/or partition associated with data being processed in the indexer 410.
Based on a bucket roll-over policy, the partition manager 408 can instruct the indexer 410 to convert editable groups of data or buckets to non-editable groups or buckets and/or copy the data associated with the partition to common storage 216. In some embodiments, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that the data associated with the particular partition, which may have been indexed by the indexer 410 and stored in the data store 412 in various buckets, is to be copied to common storage 216 based on a determination that the size of the data associated with the particular partition satisfies a threshold size. In some cases, the bucket roll-over policy can include different threshold sizes for different partitions. In other implementations the bucket roll-over policy may be modified by other factors, such as an identity of a tenant associated with indexing node 404, system resource usage, which could be based on the pod or other container that contains indexing node 404, or one of the physical hardware layers with which the indexing node 404 is running, or any other appropriate factor for scaling and system performance of indexing nodes 404 or any other system component.
In certain embodiments, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate data is to be copied to common storage 216 based on a determination that the amount of data associated with all partitions (or a subset thereof) of the indexing node 404 satisfies a threshold amount. Further, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that the one or more partition managers 408 of an indexing node 404 are to communicate with each other or with the indexing node manager 406 to monitor the amount of data on the indexer 410 associated with all of the partitions (or a subset thereof) assigned to the indexing node 404 and determine that the amount of data on the indexer 410 (or data store 412) associated with all the partitions (or a subset thereof) satisfies a threshold amount. Accordingly, based on the bucket roll-over policy, one or more of the partition managers 408 or the indexing node manager 406 can instruct the indexer 410 to convert editable buckets associated with the partitions (or subsets thereof) to non-editable buckets and/or store the data associated with the partitions (or subset thereof) in common storage 216.
In certain embodiments, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that buckets are to be converted to non-editable buckets and stored in common storage based on a collective size of buckets satisfying a threshold size. In some cases, the bucket roll-over policy can use different threshold sizes for conversion and storage. For example, the bucket roll-over policy can use a first threshold size to indicate when editable buckets are to be converted to non-editable buckets (e.g., stop writing to the buckets) and a second threshold size to indicate when the data (or buckets) are to be stored in common storage 216. In certain cases, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that the partition manager(s) 408 are to send a single command to the indexer 410 that causes the indexer 410 to convert editable buckets to non-editable buckets and store the buckets in common storage 216.
Based on an acknowledgement that the data associated with a partition (or multiple partitions as the case may be) has been stored in common storage 216, the partition manager 408 can communicate to the intake system 210, either directly, or through the indexing node manager 406, that the data has been stored and/or that the location marker or read pointer can be moved or updated. In some cases, the partition manager 408 receives the acknowledgement that the data has been stored from common storage 216 and/or from the indexer 410. In certain embodiments, which will be described in more detail herein, the intake system 210 does not receive communication that the data stored in intake system 210 has been read and processed until after that data has been stored in common storage 216.
The acknowledgement that the data has been stored in common storage 216 can also include location information about the data within the common storage 216. For example, the acknowledgement can provide a link, map, or path to the copied data in the common storage 216. Using the information about the data stored in common storage 216, the partition manager 408 can update the data store catalog 220. For example, the partition manager 408 can update the data store catalog 220 with an identifier of the data (e.g., bucket identifier, tenant identifier, partition identifier, etc.), the location of the data in common storage 216, a time range associated with the data, etc. In this way, the data store catalog 220 can be kept up-to-date with the contents of the common storage 216.
Moreover, as additional data is received from the intake system 210, the partition manager 408 can continue to communicate the data to the indexer 410, monitor the size or amount of data on the indexer 410, instruct the indexer 410 to copy the data to common storage 216, communicate the successful storage of the data to the intake system 210, and update the data store catalog 220.
As a non-limiting example, consider the scenario in which the intake system 210 communicates data from a particular shard or partition to the indexing system 212. The intake system 210 can track which data it has sent and a location marker for the data in the intake system 210 (e.g., a marker that identifies data that has been sent to the indexing system 212 for processing).
As described herein, the intake system 210 can retain or persistently make available the sent data until the intake system 210 receives an acknowledgement from the indexing system 212 that the sent data has been processed, stored in persistent storage (e.g., common storage 216), or is safe to be deleted. In this way, if an indexing node 404 assigned to process the sent data becomes unresponsive or is lost, e.g., due to a hardware failure or a crash of the indexing node manager 406 or other component, process, or daemon, the data that was sent to the unresponsive indexing node 404 will not be lost. Rather, a different indexing node 404 can obtain and process the data from the intake system 210.
As the indexing system 212 stores the data in common storage 216, it can report the storage to the intake system 210. In response, the intake system 210 can update its marker to identify different data that has been sent to the indexing system 212 for processing, but has not yet been stored. By moving the marker, the intake system 210 can indicate that the previously-identified data has been stored in common storage 216, can be deleted from the intake system 210 or, otherwise, can be allowed to be overwritten, lost, etc.
With reference to the example above, in some embodiments, the indexing node manager 406 can track the marker used by the ingestion buffer 310, and the partition manager 408 can receive the data from the ingestion buffer 310 and forward it to an indexer 410 for processing (or use the data in the ingestion buffer to obtain data from a referenced storage location and forward the obtained data to the indexer). The partition manager 408 can monitor the amount of data being processed and instruct the indexer 410 to copy the data to common storage 216. Once the data is stored in common storage 216, the partition manager 408 can report the storage to the ingestion buffer 310, so that the ingestion buffer 310 can update its marker. In addition, the indexing node manager 406 can update its records with the location of the updated marker. In this way, if partition manager 408 become unresponsive or fails, the indexing node manager 406 can assign a different partition manager 408 to obtain the data from the data stream without losing the location information, or if the indexer 410 becomes unavailable or fails, the indexing node manager 406 can assign a different indexer 410 to process and store the data.
3.2.2.3. Indexer and Data Store
As described herein, the indexer 410 can be the primary indexing execution engine, and can be implemented as a distinct computing device, container, container within a pod, etc. For example, the indexer 410 can tasked with parsing, processing, indexing, and storing the data received from the intake system 210 via the partition manager(s) 408. Specifically, in some embodiments, the indexer 410 can parse the incoming data to identify timestamps, generate events from the incoming data, group and save events into buckets, generate summaries or indexes (e.g., time series index, inverted index, keyword index, etc.) of the events in the buckets, and store the buckets in common storage 216.
In some cases, one indexer 410 can be assigned to each partition manager 408, and in certain embodiments, one indexer 410 can receive and process the data from multiple (or all) partition mangers 408 on the same indexing node 404 or from multiple indexing nodes 404.
In some embodiments, the indexer 410 can store the events and buckets in the data store 412 according to a bucket creation policy. The bucket creation policy can indicate how many buckets the indexer 410 is to generate for the data that it processes. In some cases, based on the bucket creation policy, the indexer 410 generates at least one bucket for each tenant and index (also referred to as a partition) associated with the data that it processes. For example, if the indexer 410 receives data associated with three tenants A, B, C, each with two indexes X, Y, then the indexer 410 can generate at least six buckets: at least one bucket for each of Tenant A::Index X, Tenant A::Index Y, Tenant B::Index X, Tenant B::Index Y, Tenant C::Index X, and Tenant C::Index Y. Additional buckets may be generated for a tenant/partition pair based on the amount of data received that is associated with the tenant/partition pair. However, it will be understood that the indexer 410 can generate buckets using a variety of policies. For example, the indexer 410 can generate one or more buckets for each tenant, partition, source, sourcetype, etc.
In some cases, if the indexer 410 receives data that it determines to be “old,” e.g., based on a timestamp of the data or other temporal determination regarding the data, then it can generate a bucket for the “old” data. In some embodiments, the indexer 410 can determine that data is “old,” if the data is associated with a timestamp that is earlier in time by a threshold amount than timestamps of other data in the corresponding bucket (e.g., depending on the bucket creation policy, data from the same partition and/or tenant) being processed by the indexer 410. For example, if the indexer 410 is processing data for the bucket for Tenant A::Index X having timestamps on 4/23 between 16:23:56 and 16:46:32 and receives data for the Tenant A::Index X bucket having a timestamp on 4/22 or on 4/23 at 08:05:32, then it can determine that the data with the earlier timestamps is “old” data and generate a new bucket for that data. In this way, the indexer 410 can avoid placing data in the same bucket that creates a time range that is significantly larger than the time range of other buckets, which can decrease the performance of the system as the bucket could be identified as relevant for a search more often than it otherwise would.
The threshold amount of time used to determine if received data is “old,” can be predetermined or dynamically determined based on a number of factors, such as, but not limited to, time ranges of other buckets, amount of data being processed, timestamps of the data being processed, etc. For example, the indexer 410 can determine an average time range of buckets that it processes for different tenants and indexes. If incoming data would cause the time range of a bucket to be significantly larger (e.g., 25%, 50%, 75%, double, or other amount) than the average time range, then the indexer 410 can determine that the data is “old” data, and generate a separate bucket for it. By placing the “old” bucket in a separate bucket, the indexer 410 can reduce the instances in which the bucket is identified as storing data that may be relevant to a query. For example, by having a smaller time range, the query system 214 may identify the bucket less frequently as a relevant bucket then if the bucket had the large time range due to the “old” data. Additionally, in a process that will be described in more detail herein, time-restricted searches and search queries may be executed more quickly because there may be fewer buckets to search for a particular time range. In this manner, computational efficiency of searching large amounts of data can be improved. Although described with respect detecting “old” data, the indexer 410 can use similar techniques to determine that “new” data should be placed in a new bucket or that a time gap between data in a bucket and “new” data is larger than a threshold amount such that the “new” data should be stored in a separate bucket.
Once a particular bucket satisfies a size threshold, the indexer 410 can store the bucket in or copy the bucket to common storage 216. In certain embodiments, the partition manager 408 can monitor the size of the buckets and instruct the indexer 410 to copy the bucket to common storage 216. The threshold size can be predetermined or dynamically determined.
In certain embodiments, the partition manager 408 can monitor the size of multiple, or all, buckets associated with the partition being managed by the partition manager 408, and based on the collective size of the buckets satisfying a threshold size, instruct the indexer 410 to copy the buckets associated with the partition to common storage 216. In certain cases, one or more partition managers 408 or the indexing node manager 406 can monitor the size of buckets across multiple, or all partitions, associated with the indexing node 404, and instruct the indexer to copy the buckets to common storage 216 based on the size of the buckets satisfying a threshold size.
As described herein, buckets in the data store 412 that are being edited by the indexer 410 can be referred to as hot buckets or editable buckets. For example, the indexer 410 can add data, events, and indexes to editable buckets in the data store 412, etc. Buckets in the data store 412 that are no longer edited by the indexer 410 can be referred to as warm buckets or non-editable buckets. In some embodiments, once the indexer 410 determines that a hot bucket is to be copied to common storage 216, it can convert the hot (editable) bucket to a warm (non-editable) bucket, and then move or copy the warm bucket to the common storage 216. Once the warm bucket is moved or copied to common storage 216, the indexer 410 can notify the partition manager 408 that the data associated with the warm bucket has been processed and stored. As mentioned, the partition manager 408 can relay the information to the intake system 210. In addition, the indexer 410 can provide the partition manager 408 with information about the buckets stored in common storage 216, such as, but not limited to, location information, tenant identifier, index identifier, time range, etc. As described herein, the partition manager 408 can use this information to update the data store catalog 220. 3.2.3. BUCKET MANAGER
The bucket manager 414 can manage the buckets stored in the data store 412, and can be implemented as a distinct computing device, virtual machine, container, container of a pod, or a process or thread associated with a container. In some cases, the bucket manager 414 can be implemented as part of the indexer 410, indexing node 404, or as a separate component of the indexing system 212.
As described herein, the indexer 410 stores data in the data store 412 as one or more buckets associated with different tenants, indexes, etc. In some cases, the contents of the buckets are not searchable by the query system 214 until they are stored in common storage 216. For example, the query system 214 may be unable to identify data responsive to a query that is located in hot (editable) buckets in the data store 412 and/or the warm (non-editable) buckets in the data store 412 that have not been copied to common storage 216. Thus, query results may be incomplete or inaccurate, or slowed as the data in the buckets of the data store 412 are copied to common storage 216.
To decrease the delay between processing and/or indexing the data and making that data searchable, the indexing system 212 can use a bucket roll-over policy that instructs the indexer 410 to convert hot buckets to warm buckets more frequently (or convert based on a smaller threshold size) and/or copy the warm buckets to common storage 216. While converting hot buckets to warm buckets more frequently or based on a smaller storage size can decrease the lag between processing the data and making it searchable, it can increase the storage size and overhead of buckets in common storage 216. For example, each bucket may have overhead associated with it, in terms of storage space required, processor power required, or other resource requirement. Thus, more buckets in common storage 216 can result in more storage used for overhead than for storing data, which can lead to increased storage size and costs. In addition, a larger number of buckets in common storage 216 can increase query times, as the opening of each bucket as part of a query can have certain processing overhead or time delay associated with it.
To decrease search times and reduce overhead and storage associated with the buckets (while maintaining a reduced delay between processing the data and making it searchable), the bucket manager 414 can monitor the buckets stored in the data store 412 and/or common storage 216 and merge buckets according to a bucket merge policy. For example, the bucket manager 414 can monitor and merge warm buckets stored in the data store 412 before, after, or concurrently with the indexer copying warm buckets to common storage 216.
The bucket merge policy can indicate which buckets are candidates for a merge or which bucket to merge (e.g., based on time ranges, size, tenant/partition or other identifiers), the number of buckets to merge, size or time range parameters for the merged buckets, and/or a frequency for creating the merged buckets. For example, the bucket merge policy can indicate that a certain number of buckets are to be merged, regardless of size of the buckets. As another non-limiting example, the bucket merge policy can indicate that multiple buckets are to be merged until a threshold bucket size is reached (e.g., 750 MB, or 1 GB, or more). As yet another non-limiting example, the bucket merge policy can indicate that buckets having a time range within a set period of time (e.g., 30 sec, 1 min., etc.) are to be merged, regardless of the number or size of the buckets being merged.
In addition, the bucket merge policy can indicate which buckets are to be merged or include additional criteria for merging buckets. For example, the bucket merge policy can indicate that only buckets having the same tenant identifier and/or partition are to be merged, or set constraints on the size of the time range for a merged bucket (e.g., the time range of the merged bucket is not to exceed an average time range of buckets associated with the same source, tenant, partition, etc.). In certain embodiments, the bucket merge policy can indicate that buckets that are older than a threshold amount (e.g., one hour, one day, etc.) are candidates for a merge or that a bucket merge is to take place once an hour, once a day, etc. In certain embodiments, the bucket merge policy can indicate that buckets are to be merged based on a determination that the number or size of warm buckets in the data store 412 of the indexing node 404 satisfies a threshold number or size, or the number or size of warm buckets associated with the same tenant identifier and/or partition satisfies the threshold number or size. It will be understood, that the bucket manager 414 can use any one or any combination of the aforementioned or other criteria for the bucket merge policy to determine when, how, and which buckets to merge.
Once a group of buckets are merged into one or more merged buckets, the bucket manager 414 can copy or instruct the indexer 406 to copy the merged buckets to common storage 216. Based on a determination that the merged buckets are successfully copied to the common storage 216, the bucket manager 414 can delete the merged buckets and the buckets used to generate the merged buckets (also referred to herein as unmerged buckets or pre-merged buckets) from the data store 412.
In some cases, the bucket manager 414 can also remove or instruct the common storage 216 to remove corresponding pre-merged buckets from the common storage 216 according to a bucket management policy. The bucket management policy can indicate when the pre-merged buckets are to be deleted or designated as able to be overwritten from common storage 216.
In some cases, the bucket management policy can indicate that the pre-merged buckets are to be deleted immediately, once any queries relying on the pre-merged buckets are completed, after a predetermined amount of time, etc. In some cases, the pre-merged buckets may be in use or identified for use by one or more queries. Removing the pre-merged buckets from common storage 216 in the middle of a query may cause one or more failures in the query system 214 or result in query responses that are incomplete or erroneous. Accordingly, the bucket management policy, in some cases, can indicate to the common storage 216 that queries that arrive before a merged bucket is stored in common storage 216 are to use the corresponding pre-merged buckets and queries that arrive after the merged bucket is stored in common storage 216 are to use the merged bucket.
Further, the bucket management policy can indicate that once queries using the pre-merged buckets are completed, the buckets are to be removed from common storage 216. However, it will be understood that the bucket management policy can indicate removal of the buckets in a variety of ways. For example, per the bucket management policy, the common storage 216 can remove the buckets after on one or more hours, one day, one week, etc., with or without regard to queries that may be relying on the pre-merged buckets. In some embodiments, the bucket management policy can indicate that the pre-merged buckets are to be removed without regard to queries relying on the pre-merged buckets and that any queries relying on the pre-merged buckets are to be redirected to the merged bucket.
In addition to removing the pre-merged buckets and merged bucket from the data store 412 and removing or instructing common storage 216 to remove the pre-merged buckets from the data store(s) 218, the bucket manger 414 can update the data store catalog 220 or cause the indexer 410 or partition manager 408 to update the data store catalog 220 with the relevant changes. These changes can include removing reference to the pre-merged buckets in the data store catalog 220 and/or adding information about the merged bucket, including, but not limited to, a bucket, tenant, and/or partition identifier associated with the merged bucket, a time range of the merged bucket, location information of the merged bucket in common storage 216, etc. In this way, the data store catalog 220 can be kept up-to-date with the contents of the common storage 216.
3.3. Query System
In the illustrated embodiment, the query system 214 includes one or more query system managers 502 (collectively or individually referred to as query system manager 502), one or more search heads 504 (collectively or individually referred to as search head 504 or search heads 504), one or more search nodes 506 (collectively or individually referred to as search node 506 or search nodes 506), a search node monitor 508, and a search node catalog 510. However, it will be understood that the query system 214 can include fewer or more components as desired. For example, in some embodiments, the common storage 216, data store catalog 220, or query acceleration data store 222 can form part of the query system 214, etc.
As described herein, each of the components of the query system 214 can be implemented using one or more computing devices as distinct computing devices or as one or more container instances or virtual machines across one or more computing devices. For example, in some embodiments, the query system manager 502, search heads 504, and search nodes 506 can be implemented as distinct computing devices with separate hardware, memory, and processors. In certain embodiments, the query system manager 502, search heads 504, and search nodes 506 can be implemented on the same or across different computing devices as distinct container instances, with each container having access to a subset of the resources of a host computing device (e.g., a subset of the memory or processing time of the processors of the host computing device), but sharing a similar operating system. In some cases, the components can be implemented as distinct virtual machines across one or more computing devices, where each virtual machine can have its own unshared operating system but shares the underlying hardware with other virtual machines on the same host computing device.
3.3.1. Query System Manager
As mentioned, the query system manager 502 can monitor and manage the search heads 504 and search nodes 506, and can be implemented as a distinct computing device, virtual machine, container, container of a pod, or a process or thread associated with a container. For example, the query system manager 502 can determine which search head 504 is to handle an incoming query or determine whether to generate an additional search node 506 based on the number of queries received by the query system 214 or based on another search node 506 becoming unavailable or unresponsive. Similarly, the query system manager 502 can determine that additional search heads 504 should be generated to handle an influx of queries or that some search heads 504 can be de-allocated or terminated based on a reduction in the number of queries received.
In certain embodiments, the query system 214 can include one query system manager 502 to manage all search heads 504 and search nodes 506 of the query system 214. In some embodiments, the query system 214 can include multiple query system managers 502. For example, a query system manager 502 can be instantiated for each computing device (or group of computing devices) configured as a host computing device for multiple search heads 504 and/or search nodes 506.
Moreover, the query system manager 502 can handle resource management, creation, assignment, or destruction of search heads 504 and/or search nodes 506, high availability, load balancing, application upgrades/rollbacks, logging and monitoring, storage, networking, service discovery, and performance and scalability, and otherwise handle containerization management of the containers of the query system 214. In certain embodiments, the query system manager 502 can be implemented using Kubernetes or Swarm. For example, in certain embodiments, the query system manager 502 may be part of a sidecar or sidecar container, that allows communication between various search nodes 506, various search heads 504, and/or combinations thereof.
In some cases, the query system manager 502 can monitor the available resources of a host computing device and/or request additional resources in a shared resource environment, based on workload of the search heads 504 and/or search nodes 506 or create, destroy, or reassign search heads 504 and/or search nodes 506 based on workload. Further, the query system manager 502 system can assign search heads 504 to handle incoming queries and/or assign search nodes 506 to handle query processing based on workload, system resources, etc.
3.3.2. Search Head
As described herein, the search heads 504 can manage the execution of queries received by the query system 214. For example, the search heads 504 can parse the queries to identify the set of data to be processed and the manner of processing the set of data, identify the location of the data, identify tasks to be performed by the search head and tasks to be performed by the search nodes 506, distribute the query (or sub-queries corresponding to the query) to the search nodes 506, apply extraction rules to the set of data to be processed, aggregate search results from the search nodes 506, store the search results in the query acceleration data store 222, etc.
As described herein, the search heads 504 can be implemented on separate computing devices or as containers or virtual machines in a virtualization environment. In some embodiments, the search heads 504 may be implemented using multiple-related containers. In certain embodiments, such as in a Kubernetes deployment, each search head 504 can be implemented as a separate container or pod. For example, one or more of the components of the search head 504 can be implemented as different containers of a single pod, e.g., on a containerization platform, such as Docker, the one or more components of the indexing node can be implemented as different Docker containers managed by synchronization platforms such as Kubernetes or Swarm. Accordingly, reference to a containerized search head 504 can refer to the search head 504 as being a single container or as one or more components of the search head 504 being implemented as different, related containers.
In the illustrated embodiment, the search head 504 includes a search master 512 and one or more search managers 514 to carry out its various functions. However, it will be understood that the search head 504 can include fewer or more components as desired. For example, the search head 504 can include multiple search masters 512.
3.3.2.1. Search Master
The search master 512 can manage the execution of the various queries assigned to the search head 504, and can be implemented as a distinct computing device, virtual machine, container, container of a pod, or a process or thread associated with a container. For example, in certain embodiments, as the search head 504 is assigned a query, the search master 512 can generate one or more search manager(s) 514 to manage the query. In some cases, the search master 512 generates a separate search manager 514 for each query that is received by the search head 504. In addition, once a query is completed, the search master 512 can handle the termination of the corresponding search manager 514.
In certain embodiments, the search master 512 can track and store the queries assigned to the different search managers 514. Accordingly, if a search manager 514 becomes unavailable or unresponsive, the search master 512 can generate a new search manager 514 and assign the query to the new search manager 514. In this way, the search head 504 can increase the resiliency of the query system 214, reduce delay caused by an unresponsive component, and can aid in providing a stateless searching service.
In some embodiments, the search master 512 is implemented as a background process, or daemon, on the search head 504 and the search manager(s) 514 are implemented as threads, copies, or forks of the background process. In some cases, a search master 512 can copy itself, or fork, to create a search manager 514 or cause a template process to copy itself, or fork, to create each new search manager 514, etc., in order to support efficient multithreaded implementations
3.3.2.2. Search Manager
As mentioned, the search managers 514 can manage the processing and execution of the queries assigned to the search head 504, and can be implemented as a distinct computing device, virtual machine, container, container of a pod, or a process or thread associated with a container. In some embodiments, one search manager 514 manages the processing and execution of one query at a time. In such embodiments, if the search head 504 is processing one hundred queries, the search master 512 can generate one hundred search managers 514 to manage the one hundred queries. Upon completing an assigned query, the search manager 514 can await assignment to a new query or be terminated.
As part of managing the processing and execution of a query, and as described herein, a search manager 514 can parse the query to identify the set of data and the manner in which the set of data is to be processed (e.g., the transformations that are to be applied to the set of data), determine tasks to be performed by the search manager 514 and tasks to be performed by the search nodes 506, identify search nodes 506 that are available to execute the query, map search nodes 506 to the set of data that is to be processed, instruct the search nodes 506 to execute the query and return results, aggregate and/or transform the search results from the various search nodes 506, and provide the search results to a user and/or to the query acceleration data store 222.
In some cases, to aid in identifying the set of data to be processed, the search manager 514 can consult the data store catalog 220 (depicted in
As a non-limiting example, consider a search manager 514 that has parsed a query to identify the following filter criteria that is used to identify the data to be processed: time range: past hour, partition: sales, tenant: ABC, Inc., keyword: Error. Using the received filter criteria, the search manager 514 can consult the data store catalog 220. Specifically, the search manager 514 can use the data store catalog 220 to identify buckets associated with the sales partition and the tenant ABC, Inc. and that include data from the past hour. In some cases, the search manager 514 can obtain bucket identifiers and location information from the data store catalog 220 for the buckets storing data that satisfies at least the aforementioned filter criteria. In certain embodiments, if the data store catalog 220 includes keyword pairs, it can use the keyword: Error to identify buckets that have at least one event that include the keyword Error.
Using the bucket identifiers and/or the location information, the search manager 514 can assign one or more search nodes 506 to search the corresponding buckets. Accordingly, the data store catalog 220 can be used to identify relevant buckets and reduce the number of buckets that are to be searched by the search nodes 506. In this way, the data store catalog 220 can decrease the query response time of the data intake and query system 108.
In some embodiments, the use of the data store catalog 220 to identify buckets for searching can contribute to the statelessness of the query system 214 and search head 504. For example, if a search head 504 or search manager 514 becomes unresponsive or unavailable, the query system manager 502 or search master 512, as the case may be, can spin up or assign an additional resource (new search head 504 or new search manager 514) to execute the query. As the bucket information is persistently stored in the data store catalog 220, data lost due to the unavailability or unresponsiveness of a component of the query system 214 can be recovered by using the bucket information in the data store catalog 220.
In certain embodiments, to identify search nodes 506 that are available to execute the query, the search manager 514 can consult the search node catalog 510. As described herein, the search node catalog 510 can include information regarding the search nodes 506. In some cases, the search node catalog 510 can include an identifier for each search node 506, as well as utilization and availability information. For example, the search node catalog 510 can identify search nodes 506 that are instantiated but are unavailable or unresponsive. In addition, the search node catalog 510 can identify the utilization rate of the search nodes 506. For example, the search node catalog 510 can identify search nodes 506 that are working at maximum capacity or at a utilization rate that satisfies utilization threshold, such that the search node 506 should not be used to execute additional queries for a time.
In addition, the search node catalog 510 can include architectural information about the search nodes 506. For example, the search node catalog 510 can identify search nodes 506 that share a data store and/or are located on the same computing device, or on computing devices that are co-located.
Accordingly, in some embodiments, based on the receipt of a query, a search manager 514 can consult the search node catalog 510 for search nodes 506 that are available to execute the received query. Based on the consultation of the search node catalog 510, the search manager 514 can determine which search nodes 506 to assign to execute the query.
The search manager 514 can map the search nodes 506 to the data that is to be processed according to a search node mapping policy. The search node mapping policy can indicate how search nodes 506 are to be assigned to data (e.g., buckets) and when search nodes 506 are to be assigned to (and instructed to search) the data or buckets.
In some cases, the search manager 514 can map the search nodes 506 to buckets that include data that satisfies at least a portion of the query. For example, in some cases, the search manager 514 can consult the data store catalog 220 to obtain bucket identifiers of buckets that include data that satisfies at least a portion of the query, e.g., as a non-limiting example, to obtain bucket identifiers of buckets that include data associated with a particular time range. Based on the identified buckets and search nodes 506, the search manager 514 can dynamically assign (or map) search nodes 506 to individual buckets according to a search node mapping policy.
In some embodiments, the search node mapping policy can indicate that the search manager 514 is to assign all buckets to search nodes 506 as a single operation. For example, where ten buckets are to be searched by five search nodes 506, the search manager 514 can assign two buckets to a first search node 506, two buckets to a second search node 506, etc. In another embodiment, the search node mapping policy can indicate that the search manager 514 is to assign buckets iteratively. For example, where ten buckets are to be searched by five search nodes 506, the search manager 514 can initially assign five buckets (e.g., one buckets to each search node 506), and assign additional buckets to each search node 506 as the respective search nodes 506 complete the execution on the assigned buckets.
Retrieving buckets from common storage 216 to be searched by the search nodes 506 can cause delay or may use a relatively high amount of network bandwidth or disk read/write bandwidth. In some cases, a local or shared data store associated with the search nodes 506 may include a copy of a bucket that was previously retrieved from common storage 216. Accordingly, to reduce delay caused by retrieving buckets from common storage 216, the search node mapping policy can indicate that the search manager 514 is to assign, preferably assign, or attempt to assign the same search node 506 to search the same bucket over time. In this way, the assigned search node 506 can keep a local copy of the bucket on its data store (or a data store shared between multiple search nodes 506) and avoid the processing delays associated with obtaining the bucket from the common storage 216.
In certain embodiments, the search node mapping policy can indicate that the search manager 514 is to use a consistent hash function or other function to consistently map a bucket to a particular search node 506. The search manager 514 can perform the hash using the bucket identifier obtained from the data store catalog 220, and the output of the hash can be used to identify the search node 506 assigned to the bucket. In some cases, the consistent hash function can be configured such that even with a different number of search nodes 506 being assigned to execute the query, the output will consistently identify the same search node 506, or have an increased probability of identifying the same search node 506.
In some embodiments, the query system 214 can store a mapping of search nodes 506 to bucket identifiers. The search node mapping policy can indicate that the search manager 514 is to use the mapping to determine whether a particular bucket has been assigned to a search node 506. If the bucket has been assigned to a particular search node 506 and that search node 506 is available, then the search manager 514 can assign the bucket to the search node 506. If the bucket has not been assigned to a particular search node 506, the search manager 514 can use a hash function to identify a search node 506 for assignment. Once assigned, the search manager 514 can store the mapping for future use.
In certain cases, the search node mapping policy can indicate that the search manager 514 is to use architectural information about the search nodes 506 to assign buckets. For example, if the identified search node 506 is unavailable or its utilization rate satisfies a threshold utilization rate, the search manager 514 can determine whether an available search node 506 shares a data store with the unavailable search node 506. If it does, the search manager 514 can assign the bucket to the available search node 506 that shares the data store with the unavailable search node 506. In this way, the search manager 514 can reduce the likelihood that the bucket will be obtained from common storage 216, which can introduce additional delay to the query while the bucket is retrieved from common storage 216 to the data store shared by the available search node 506.
In some instances, the search node mapping policy can indicate that the search manager 514 is to assign buckets to search nodes 506 randomly, or in a simple sequence (e.g., a first search nodes 506 is assigned a first bucket, a second search node 506 is assigned a second bucket, etc.). In other instances, as discussed, the search node mapping policy can indicate that the search manager 514 is to assign buckets to search nodes 506 based on buckets previously assigned to a search nodes 506, in a prior or current search. As mentioned above, in some embodiments each search node 506 may be associated with a local data store or cache of information (e.g., in memory of the search nodes 506, such as random access memory [“RAM”], disk-based cache, a data store, or other form of storage). Each search node 506 can store copies of one or more buckets from the common storage 216 within the local cache, such that the buckets may be more rapidly searched by search nodes 506. The search manager 514 (or cache manager 516) can maintain or retrieve from search nodes 506 information identifying, for each relevant search node 506, what buckets are copied within local cache of the respective search nodes 506. In the event that the search manager 514 determines that a search node 506 assigned to execute a search has within its data store or local cache a copy of an identified bucket, the search manager 514 can preferentially assign the search node 506 to search that locally-cached bucket.
In still more embodiments, according to the search node mapping policy, search nodes 506 may be assigned based on overlaps of computing resources of the search nodes 506. For example, where a containerized search node 506 is to retrieve a bucket from common storage 216 (e.g., where a local cached copy of the bucket does not exist on the search node 506), such retrieval may use a relatively high amount of network bandwidth or disk read/write bandwidth. Thus, assigning a second containerized search node 506 instantiated on the same host computing device might be expected to strain or exceed the network or disk read/write bandwidth of the host computing device. For this reason, in some embodiments, according to the search node mapping policy, the search manager 514 can assign buckets to search nodes 506 such that two containerized search nodes 506 on a common host computing device do not both retrieve buckets from common storage 216 at the same time.
Further, in certain embodiments, where a data store that is shared between multiple search nodes 506 includes two buckets identified for the search, the search manager 514 can, according to the search node mapping policy, assign both such buckets to the same search node 506 or to two different search nodes 506 that share the data store, such that both buckets can be searched in parallel by the respective search nodes 506.
The search node mapping policy can indicate that the search manager 514 is to use any one or any combination of the above-described mechanisms to assign buckets to search nodes 506. Furthermore, the search node mapping policy can indicate that the search manager 514 is to prioritize assigning search nodes 506 to buckets based on any one or any combination of: assigning search nodes 506 to process buckets that are in a local or shared data store of the search nodes 506, maximizing parallelization (e.g., assigning as many different search nodes 506 to execute the query as are available), assigning search nodes 506 to process buckets with overlapping timestamps, maximizing individual search node 506 utilization (e.g., ensuring that each search node 506 is searching at least one bucket at any given time, etc.), or assigning search nodes 506 to process buckets associated with a particular tenant, user, or other known feature of data stored within the bucket (e.g., buckets holding data known to be used in time-sensitive searches may be prioritized). Thus, according to the search node mapping policy, the search manager 514 can dynamically alter the assignment of buckets to search nodes 506 to increase the parallelization of a search, and to increase the speed and efficiency with which the search is executed.
It will be understood that the search manager 514 can assign any search node 506 to search any bucket. This flexibility can decrease query response time as the search manager can dynamically determine which search nodes 506 are best suited or available to execute the query on different buckets. Further, if one bucket is being used by multiple queries, the search manager 515 can assign multiple search nodes 506 to search the bucket. In addition, in the event a search node 506 becomes unavailable or unresponsive, the search manager 514 can assign a different search node 506 to search the buckets assigned to the unavailable search node 506.
As part of the query execution, the search manager 514 can instruct the search nodes 506 to execute the query (or sub-query) on the assigned buckets. As described herein, the search manager 514 can generate specific queries or sub-queries for the individual search nodes 506. The search nodes 506 can use the queries to execute the query on the buckets assigned thereto.
In some embodiments, the search manager 514 stores the sub-queries and bucket assignments for the different search nodes 506. Storing the sub-queries and bucket assignments can contribute to the statelessness of the query system 214. For example, in the event an assigned search node 506 becomes unresponsive or unavailable during the query execution, the search manager 514 can re-assign the sub-query and bucket assignments of the unavailable search node 506 to one or more available search nodes 506 or identify a different available search node 506 from the search node catalog 510 to execute the sub-query. In certain embodiments, the query system manager 502 can generate an additional search node 506 to execute the sub-query of the unavailable search node 506. Accordingly, the query system 214 can quickly recover from an unavailable or unresponsive component without data loss and while reducing or minimizing delay.
During the query execution, the search manager 514 can monitor the status of the assigned search nodes 506. In some cases, the search manager 514 can ping or set up a communication link between it and the search nodes 506 assigned to execute the query. As mentioned, the search manager 514 can store the mapping of the buckets to the search nodes 506. Accordingly, in the event a particular search node 506 becomes unavailable for his unresponsive, the search manager 514 can assign a different search node 506 to complete the execution of the query for the buckets assigned to the unresponsive search node 506.
In some cases, as part of the status updates to the search manager 514, the search nodes 506 can provide the search manager with partial results and information regarding the buckets that have been searched. In response, the search manager 514 can store the partial results and bucket information in persistent storage. Accordingly, if a search node 506 partially executes the query and becomes unresponsive or unavailable, the search manager 514 can assign a different search node 506 to complete the execution, as described above. For example, the search manager 514 can assign a search node 506 to execute the query on the buckets that were not searched by the unavailable search node 506. In this way, the search manager 514 can more quickly recover from an unavailable or unresponsive search node 506 without data loss and while reducing or minimizing delay.
As the search manager 514 receives query results from the different search nodes 506, it can process the data. In some cases, the search manager 514 processes the partial results as it receives them. For example, if the query includes a count, the search manager 514 can increment the count as it receives the results from the different search nodes 506. In certain cases, the search manager 514 waits for the complete results from the search nodes before processing them. For example, if the query includes a command that operates on a result set, or a partial result set, e.g., a stats command (e.g., a command that calculates one or more aggregate statistics over the results set, e.g., average, count, or standard deviation, as examples), the search manager 514 can wait for the results from all the search nodes 506 before executing the stats command.
As the search manager 514 processes the results or completes processing the results, it can store the results in the query acceleration data store 222 or communicate the results to a client device 204. As described herein, results stored in the query acceleration data store 222 can be combined with other results over time. For example, if the query system 212 receives an open-ended query (e.g., no set end time), the search manager 515 can store the query results over time in the query acceleration data store 222. Query results in the query acceleration data store 222 can be updated as additional query results are obtained. In this manner, if an open-ended query is run at time B, query results may be stored from initial time A to time B. If the same open-ended query is run at time C, then the query results from the prior open-ended query can be obtained from the query acceleration data store 222 (which gives the results from time A to time B), and the query can be run from time B to time C and combined with the prior results, rather than running the entire query from time A to time C. In this manner, the computational efficiency of ongoing search queries can be improved.
3.3.3. Search Nodes
As described herein, the search nodes 506 can be the primary query execution engines for the query system 214, and can be implemented as distinct computing devices, virtual machines, containers, container of a pods, or processes or threads associated with one or more containers. Accordingly, each search node 506 can include a processing device and a data store, as depicted at a high level in
In some embodiments, the search nodes 506 can obtain and search buckets identified by the search manager 514 that include data that satisfies at least a portion of the query, identify the set of data within the buckets that satisfies the query, perform one or more transformations on the set of data, and communicate the set of data to the search manager 514. Individually, a search node 506 can obtain the buckets assigned to it by the search manager 514 for a particular query, search the assigned buckets for a subset of the set of data, perform one or more transformation on the subset of data, and communicate partial search results to the search manager 514 for additional processing and combination with the partial results from other search nodes 506.
In some cases, the buckets to be searched may be located in a local data store of the search node 506 or a data store that is shared between multiple search nodes 506. In such cases, the search nodes 506 can identify the location of the buckets and search the buckets for the set of data that satisfies the query.
In certain cases, the buckets may be located in the common storage 216. In such cases, the search nodes 506 can search the buckets in the common storage 216 and/or copy the buckets from the common storage 216 to a local or shared data store and search the locally stored copy for the set of data. As described herein, the cache manager 516 can coordinate with the search nodes 506 to identify the location of the buckets (whether in a local or shared data store or in common storage 216) and/or obtain buckets stored in common storage 216.
Once the relevant buckets (or relevant files of the buckets) are obtained, the search nodes 506 can search their contents to identify the set of data to be processed. In some cases, upon obtaining a bucket from the common storage 216, a search node 506 can decompress the bucket from a compressed format, and accessing one or more files stored within the bucket. In some cases, the search node 506 references a bucket summary or manifest to locate one or more portions (e.g., records or individual files) of the bucket that potentially contain information relevant to the search.
In some cases, the search nodes 506 can use all of the files of a bucket to identify the set of data. In certain embodiments, the search nodes 506 use a subset of the files of a bucket to identify the set of data. For example, in some cases, a search node 506 can use an inverted index, bloom filter, or bucket summary or manifest to identify a subset of the set of data without searching the raw machine data of the bucket. In certain cases, the search node 506 uses the inverted index, bloom filter, bucket summary, and raw machine data to identify the subset of the set of data that satisfies the query.
In some embodiments, depending on the query, the search nodes 506 can perform one or more transformations on the data from the buckets. For example, the search nodes 506 may perform various data transformations, scripts, and processes, e.g., a count of the set of data, etc.
As the search nodes 506 execute the query, they can provide the search manager 514 with search results. In some cases, a search node 506 provides the search manager 514 results as they are identified by the search node 506, and updates the results over time. In certain embodiments, a search node 506 waits until all of its partial results are gathered before sending the results to the search manager 504.
In some embodiments, the search nodes 506 provide a status of the query to the search manager 514. For example, an individual search node 506 can inform the search manager 514 of which buckets it has searched and/or provide the search manager 514 with the results from the searched buckets. As mentioned, the search manager 514 can track or store the status and the results as they are received from the search node 506. In the event the search node 506 becomes unresponsive or unavailable, the tracked information can be used to generate and assign a new search node 506 to execute the remaining portions of the query assigned to the unavailable search node 506.
3.3.4. Cache Manager
As mentioned, the cache manager 516 can communicate with the search nodes 506 to obtain or identify the location of the buckets assigned to the search nodes 506, and can be implemented as a distinct computing device, virtual machine, container, container of a pod, or a process or thread associated with a container.
In some embodiments, based on the receipt of a bucket assignment, a search node 506 can provide the cache manager 516 with an identifier of the bucket that it is to search, a file associated with the bucket that it is to search, and/or a location of the bucket. In response, the cache manager 516 can determine whether the identified bucket or file is located in a local or shared data store or is to be retrieved from the common storage 216.
As mentioned, in some cases, multiple search nodes 506 can share a data store. Accordingly, if the cache manager 516 determines that the requested bucket is located in a local or shared data store, the cache manager 516 can provide the search node 506 with the location of the requested bucket or file. In certain cases, if the cache manager 516 determines that the requested bucket or file is not located in the local or shared data store, the cache manager 516 can request the bucket or file from the common storage 216, and inform the search node 506 that the requested bucket or file is being retrieved from common storage 216.
In some cases, the cache manager 516 can request one or more files associated with the requested bucket prior to, or in place of, requesting all contents of the bucket from the common storage 216. For example, a search node 506 may request a subset of files from a particular bucket. Based on the request and a determination that the files are located in common storage 216, the cache manager 516 can download or obtain the identified files from the common storage 216.
In some cases, based on the information provided from the search node 506, the cache manager 516 may be unable to uniquely identify a requested file or files within the common storage 216. Accordingly, in certain embodiments, the cache manager 516 can retrieve a bucket summary or manifest file from the common storage 216 and provide the bucket summary to the search node 506. In some cases, the cache manager 516 can provide the bucket summary to the search node 506 while concurrently informing the search node 506 that the requested files are not located in a local or shared data store and are to be retrieved from common storage 216.
Using the bucket summary, the search node 506 can uniquely identify the files to be used to execute the query. Using the unique identification, the cache manager 516 can request the files from the common storage 216. Accordingly, rather than downloading the entire contents of the bucket from common storage 216, the cache manager 516 can download those portions of the bucket that are to be used by the search node 506 to execute the query. In this way, the cache manager 516 can decrease the amount of data sent over the network and decrease the search time.
As a non-limiting example, a search node 506 may determine that an inverted index of a bucket is to be used to execute a query. For example, the search node 506 may determine that all the information that it needs to execute the query on the bucket can be found in an inverted index associated with the bucket. Accordingly, the search node 506 can request the file associated with the inverted index of the bucket from the cache manager 516. Based on a determination that the requested file is not located in a local or shared data store, the cache manager 516 can determine that the file is located in the common storage 216.
As the bucket may have multiple inverted indexes associated with it, the information provided by the search node 506 may be insufficient to uniquely identify the inverted index within the bucket. To address this issue, the cache manager 516 can request a bucket summary or manifest from the common storage 216, and forward it to the search node 506. The search node 506 can analyze the bucket summary to identify the particular inverted index that is to be used to execute the query, and request the identified particular inverted index from the cache manager 516 (e.g., by name and/or location). Using the bucket manifest and/or the information received from the search node 506, the cache manager 516 can obtain the identified particular inverted index from the common storage 216. By obtaining the bucket manifest and downloading the requested inverted index instead of all inverted indexes or files of the bucket, the cache manager 516 can reduce the amount of data communicated over the network and reduce the search time for the query.
In some cases, when requesting a particular file, the search node 506 can include a priority level for the file. For example, the files of a bucket may be of different sizes and may be used more or less frequently when executing queries. For example, the bucket manifest may be a relatively small file. However, if the bucket is searched, the bucket manifest can be a relatively valuable file (and frequently used) because it includes a list or index of the various files of the bucket. Similarly, a bloom filter of a bucket may be a relatively small file but frequently used as it can relatively quickly identify the contents of the bucket. In addition, an inverted index may be used more frequently than raw data of a bucket to satisfy a query.
Accordingly, to improve retention of files that are commonly used in a search of a bucket, the search node 506 can include a priority level for the requested file. The cache manager 516 can use the priority level received from the search node 506 to determine how long to keep or when to evict the file from the local or shared data store. For example, files identified by the search node 506 as having a higher priority level can be stored for a greater period of time than files identified as having a lower priority level.
Furthermore, the cache manager 516 can determine what data and how long to retain the data in the local or shared data stores of the search nodes 506 based on a bucket caching policy. In some cases, the bucket caching policy can rely on any one or any combination of the priority level received from the search nodes 506 for a particular file, least recently used, most recent in time, or other policies to indicate how long to retain files in the local or shared data store.
In some instances, according to the bucket caching policy, the cache manager 516 or other component of the query system 214 (e.g., the search master 512 or search manager 514) can instruct search nodes 506 to retrieve and locally cache copies of various buckets from the common storage 216, independently of processing queries. In certain embodiments, the query system 214 is configured, according to the bucket caching policy, such that one or more buckets from the common storage 216 (e.g., buckets associated with a tenant or partition of a tenant) or each bucket from the common storage 216 is locally cached on at least one search node 506.
In some embodiments, according to the bucket caching policy, the query system 214 is configured such that at least one bucket from the common storage 216 is locally cached on at least two search nodes 506. Caching a bucket on at least two search nodes 506 may be beneficial, for example, in instances where different queries both require searching the bucket (e.g., because the at least search nodes 506 may process their respective local copies in parallel). In still other embodiments, the query system 214 is configured, according to the bucket caching policy, such that one or more buckets from the common storage 216 or all buckets from the common storage 216 are locally cached on at least a given number n of search nodes 506, wherein n is defined by a replication factor on the system 108. For example, a replication factor of five may be established to ensure that five copies of a bucket are locally cached across different search nodes 506.
In certain embodiments, the search manager 514 (or search master 512) can assign buckets to different search nodes 506 based on time. For example, buckets that are less than one day old can be assigned to a first group of search nodes 506 for caching, buckets that are more than one day but less than one week old can be assigned to a different group of search nodes 506 for caching, and buckets that are more than one week old can be assigned to a third group of search nodes 506 for caching. In certain cases, the first group can be larger than the second group, and the second group can be larger than the third group. In this way, the query system 214 can provide better/faster results for queries searching data that is less than one day old, and so on, etc. It will be understood that the search nodes can be grouped and assigned buckets in a variety of ways. For example, search nodes 506 can be grouped based on a tenant identifier, index, etc. In this way, the query system 212 can dynamically provide faster results based any one or any number of factors.
In some embodiments, when a search node 506 is added to the query system 214, the cache manager 516 can, based on the bucket caching policy, instruct the search node 506 to download one or more buckets from common storage 216 prior to receiving a query. In certain embodiments, the cache manager 516 can instruct the search node 506 to download specific buckets, such as most recent in time buckets, buckets associated with a particular tenant or partition, etc. In some cases, the cache manager 516 can instruct the search node 506 to download the buckets before the search node 506 reports to the search node monitor 508 that it is available for executing queries. It will be understood that other components of the query system 214 can implement this functionality, such as, but not limited to the query system manager 502, search node monitor 508, search manager 514, or the search nodes 506 themselves.
In certain embodiments, when a search node 506 is removed from the query system 214 or becomes unresponsive or unavailable, the cache manager 516 can identify the buckets that the removed search node 506 was responsible for and instruct the remaining search nodes 506 that they will be responsible for the identified buckets. In some cases, the remaining search nodes 506 can download the identified buckets from common storage 516 or retrieve them from the data store associated with the removed search node 506.
In some cases, the cache manager 516 can change the bucket-search node 506 assignments, such as when a search node 506 is removed or added. In certain embodiments, based on a reassignment, the cache manager 516 can inform a particular search node 506 to remove buckets to which it is no longer assigned, reduce the priority level of the buckets, etc. In this way, the cache manager 516 can make it so the reassigned bucket will be removed more quickly from the search node 506 than it otherwise would without the reassignment. In certain embodiments, the search node 506 that receives the new for the bucket can retrieve the bucket from the now unassigned search node 506 and/or retrieve the bucket from common storage 216.
3.3.5. Search Node Monitor and Catalog
The search node monitor 508 can monitor search nodes and populate the search node catalog 510 with relevant information, and can be implemented as a distinct computing device, virtual machine, container, container of a pod, or a process or thread associated with a container.
In some cases, the search node monitor 508 can ping the search nodes 506 over time to determine their availability, responsiveness, and/or utilization rate. In certain embodiments, each search node 506 can include a monitoring module that provides performance metrics or status updates about the search node 506 to the search node monitor 508. For example, the monitoring module can indicate the amount of processing resources in use by the search node 506, the utilization rate of the search node 506, the amount of memory used by the search node 506, etc. In certain embodiments, the search node monitor 508 can determine that a search node 506 is unavailable or failing based on the data in the status update or absence of a state update from the monitoring module of the search node 506.
Using the information obtained from the search nodes 506, the search node monitor 508 can populate the search node catalog 510 and update it over time. As described herein, the search manager 514 can use the search node catalog 510 to identify search nodes 506 available to execute a query. In some embodiments, the search manager 214 can communicate with the search node catalog 510 using an API.
As the availability, responsiveness, and/or utilization change for the different search nodes 506, the search node monitor 508 can update the search node catalog 510. In this way, the search node catalog 510 can retain an up-to-date list of search nodes 506 available to execute a query.
Furthermore, as search nodes 506 are instantiated (or at other times), the search node monitor 508 can update the search node catalog 510 with information about the search node 506, such as, but not limited to its computing resources, utilization, network architecture (identification of machine where it is instantiated, location with reference to other search nodes 506, computing resources shared with other search nodes 506, such as data stores, processors, I/O, etc.), etc.
3.4. Common Storage
Returning to
In some systems, the same computing devices (e.g., indexers) operate both to ingest, index, store, and search data. The use of an indexer to both ingest and search information may be beneficial, for example, because an indexer may have ready access to information that it has ingested, and can quickly access that information for searching purposes. However, use of an indexer to both ingest and search information may not be desirable in all instances. As an illustrative example, consider an instance in which ingested data is organized into buckets, and each indexer is responsible for maintaining buckets within a data store corresponding to the indexer. Illustratively, a set of ten indexers may maintain 100 buckets, distributed evenly across ten data stores (each of which is managed by a corresponding indexer). Information may be distributed throughout the buckets according to a load-balancing mechanism used to distribute information to the indexers during data ingestion. In an idealized scenario, information responsive to a query would be spread across the 100 buckets, such that each indexer may search their corresponding ten buckets in parallel, and provide search results to a search head. However, it is expected that this idealized scenario may not always occur, and that there will be at least some instances in which information responsive to a query is unevenly distributed across data stores. As one example, consider a query in which responsive information exists within ten buckets, all of which are included in a single data store associated with a single indexer. In such an instance, a bottleneck may be created at the single indexer, and the effects of parallelized searching across the indexers may be minimized. To increase the speed of operation of search queries in such cases, it may therefore be desirable to store data indexed by the indexing system 212 in common storage 216 that can be accessible to any one or multiple components of the indexing system 212 or the query system 214.
Common storage 216 may correspond to any data storage system accessible to the indexing system 212 and the query system 214. For example, common storage 216 may correspond to a storage area network (SAN), network attached storage (NAS), other network-accessible storage system (e.g., a hosted storage system, such as Amazon S3 or EBS provided by Amazon, Inc., Google Cloud Storage, Microsoft Azure Storage, etc., which may also be referred to as “cloud” storage), or combination thereof. The common storage 216 may include, for example, hard disk drives (HDDs), solid state storage devices (SSDs), or other substantially persistent or non-transitory media. Data stores 218 within common storage 216 may correspond to physical data storage devices (e.g., an individual HDD) or a logical storage device, such as a grouping of physical data storage devices or a containerized or virtualized storage device hosted by an underlying physical storage device. In some embodiments, the common storage 216 may also be referred to as a shared storage system or shared storage environment as the data stores 218 may store data associated with multiple customers, tenants, etc., or across different data intake and query systems 108 or other systems unrelated to the data intake and query systems 108.
The common storage 216 can be configured to provide high availability, highly resilient, low loss data storage. In some cases, to provide the high availability, highly resilient, low loss data storage, the common storage 216 can store multiple copies of the data in the same and different geographic locations and across different types of data stores (e.g., solid state, hard drive, tape, etc.). Further, as data is received at the common storage 216 it can be automatically replicated multiple times according to a replication factor to different data stores across the same and/or different geographic locations.
In one embodiment, common storage 216 may be multi-tiered, with each tier providing more rapid access to information stored in that tier. For example, a first tier of the common storage 216 may be physically co-located with the indexing system 212 or the query system 214 and provide rapid access to information of the first tier, while a second tier may be located in a different physical location (e.g., in a hosted or “cloud” computing environment) and provide less rapid access to information of the second tier.
Distribution of data between tiers may be controlled by any number of algorithms or mechanisms. In one embodiment, a first tier may include data generated or including timestamps within a threshold period of time (e.g., the past seven days), while a second tier or subsequent tiers includes data older than that time period. In another embodiment, a first tier may include a threshold amount (e.g., n terabytes) or recently accessed data, while a second tier stores the remaining less recently accessed data.
In one embodiment, data within the data stores 218 is grouped into buckets, each of which is commonly accessible to the indexing system 212 and query system 214. The size of each bucket may be selected according to the computational resources of the common storage 216 or the data intake and query system 108 overall. For example, the size of each bucket may be selected to enable an individual bucket to be relatively quickly transmitted via a network, without introducing excessive additional data storage requirements due to metadata or other overhead associated with an individual bucket. In one embodiment, each bucket is 750 megabytes in size. Further, as mentioned, in some embodiments, some buckets can be merged to create larger buckets.
As described herein, each bucket can include one or more files, such as, but not limited to, one or more compressed or uncompressed raw machine data files, metadata files, filter files, indexes files, bucket summary or manifest files, etc. In addition, each bucket can store events including raw machine data associated with a timestamp.
As described herein, the indexing nodes 404 can generate buckets during indexing and communicate with common storage 216 to store the buckets. For example, data may be provided to the indexing nodes 404 from one or more ingestion buffers of the intake system 210. The indexing nodes 404 can process the information and store it as buckets in common storage 216, rather than in a data store maintained by an individual indexer or indexing node. Thus, the common storage 216 can render information of the data intake and query system 108 commonly accessible to elements of the system 108. As described herein, the common storage 216 can enable parallelized searching of buckets to occur independently of the operation of indexing system 212.
As noted above, it may be beneficial in some instances to separate data indexing and searching. Accordingly, as described herein, the search nodes 506 of the query system 214 can search for data stored within common storage 216. The search nodes 506 may therefore be communicatively attached (e.g., via a communication network) with the common storage 216, and be enabled to access buckets within the common storage 216.
Further, as described herein, because the search nodes 506 in some instances are not statically assigned to individual data stores 218 (and thus to buckets within such a data store 218), the buckets searched by an individual search node 506 may be selected dynamically, to increase the parallelization with which the buckets can be searched. For example, consider an instance where information is stored within 100 buckets, and a query is received at the data intake and query system 108 for information within ten buckets. Unlike a scenario in which buckets are statically assigned to an indexer, which could result in a bottleneck if the ten relevant buckets are associated with the same indexer, the ten buckets holding relevant information may be dynamically distributed across multiple search nodes 506. Thus, if ten search nodes 506 are available to process a query, each search node 506 may be assigned to retrieve and search within one bucket greatly increasing parallelization when compared to the low-parallelization scenarios (e.g., where a single indexer 206 is required to search all ten buckets).
Moreover, because searching occurs at the search nodes 506 rather than at the indexing system 212, indexing resources can be allocated independently to searching operations. For example, search nodes 506 may be executed by a separate processor or computing device than indexing nodes 404, enabling computing resources available to search nodes 506 to scale independently of resources available to indexing nodes 404. Additionally, the impact on data ingestion and indexing due to above-average volumes of search query requests is reduced or eliminated, and similarly, the impact of data ingestion on search query result generation time also is reduced or eliminated.
As will be appreciated in view of the above description, the use of a common storage 216 can provide many advantages within the data intake and query system 108. Specifically, use of a common storage 216 can enable the system 108 to decouple functionality of data indexing by indexing nodes 404 with functionality of searching by search nodes 506. Moreover, because buckets containing data are accessible by each search node 506, a search manager 514 can dynamically allocate search nodes 506 to buckets at the time of a search in order to increase parallelization. Thus, use of a common storage 216 can substantially improve the speed and efficiency of operation of the system 108.
3.5. Data Store Catalog
The data store catalog 220 can store information about the data stored in common storage 216, and can be implemented using one or more data stores. In some embodiments, the data store catalog 220 can be implemented as a portion of the common storage 216 and/or using similar data storage techniques (e.g., local or cloud storage, multi-tiered storage, etc.). In another implementation, the data store catalog 22—may utilize a database, e.g., a relational database engine, such as commercially-provided relational database services, e.g., Amazon's Aurora. In some implementations, the data store catalog 220 may use an API to allow access to register buckets, and to allow query system 214 to access buckets. In other implementations, data store catalog 220 may be implemented through other means, and maybe stored as part of common storage 216, or another type of common storage, as previously described. In various implementations, requests for buckets may include a tenant identifier and some form of user authentication, e.g., a user access token that can be authenticated by authentication service. In various implementations, the data store catalog 220 may store one data structure, e.g., table, per tenant, for the buckets associated with that tenant, one data structure per partition of each tenant, etc. In other implementations, a single data structure, e.g., a single table, may be used for all tenants, and unique tenant IDs may be used to identify buckets associated with the different tenants.
As described herein, the data store catalog 220 can be updated by the indexing system 212 with information about the buckets or data stored in common storage 216. For example, the data store catalog can store an identifier for a sets of data in common storage 216, a location of the sets of data in common storage 216, tenant or indexes associated with the sets of data, timing information about the sets of data, etc. In embodiments where the data in common storage 216 is stored as buckets, the data store catalog 220 can include a bucket identifier for the buckets in common storage 216, a location of or path to the buckets in common storage 216, a time range of the data in the bucket (e.g., range of time between the first-in-time event of the bucket and the last-in-time event of the bucket), a tenant identifier identifying a customer or computing device associated with the bucket, and/or an index or partition associated with the bucket, etc.
In certain embodiments, the data store catalog 220 can include an indication of a location of a copy of a bucket found in one or more search nodes 506. For example, as buckets are copied to search nodes 506, the query system 214 can update the data store catalog 220 with information about which search nodes 506 include a copy of the buckets. This information can be used by the query system 214 to assign search nodes 506 to buckets as part of a query.
In certain embodiments, the data store catalog 220 can function as an index or inverted index of the buckets stored in common storage 216. For example, the data store catalog 220 can provide location and other information about the buckets stored in common storage 216. In some embodiments, the data store catalog 220 can provide additional information about the contents of the buckets. For example, the data store catalog 220 can provide a list of sources, sourcetypes, or hosts associated with the data in the buckets.
In certain embodiments, the data store catalog 220 can include one or more keywords found within the data of the buckets. In such embodiments, the data store catalog can be similar to an inverted index, except rather than identifying specific events associated with a particular host, source, sourcetype, or keyword, it can identify buckets with data associated with the particular host, source, sourcetype, or keyword.
In some embodiments, the query system 214 (e.g., search head 504, search master 512, search manager 514, etc.) can communicate with the data store catalog 220 as part of processing and executing a query. In certain cases, the query system 214 communicates with the data store catalog 220 using an API. As a non-limiting example, the query system 214 can provide the data store catalog 220 with at least a portion of the query or one or more filter criteria associated with the query. In response, the data store catalog 220 can provide the query system 214 with an identification of buckets that store data that satisfies at least a portion of the query. In addition, the data store catalog 220 can provide the query system 214 with an indication of the location of the identified buckets in common storage 216 and/or in one or more local or shared data stores of the search nodes 506.
Accordingly, using the information from the data store catalog 220, the query system 214 can reduce (or filter) the amount of data or number of buckets to be searched. For example, using tenant or partition information in the data store catalog 220, the query system 214 can exclude buckets associated with a tenant or a partition, respectively, that is not to be searched. Similarly, using time range information, the query system 214 can exclude buckets that do not satisfy a time range from a search. In this way, the data store catalog 220 can reduce the amount of data to be searched and decrease search times.
As mentioned, in some cases, as buckets are copied from common storage 216 to search nodes 506 as part of a query, the query system 214 can update the data store catalog 220 with the location information of the copy of the bucket. The query system 214 can use this information to assign search nodes 506 to buckets. For example, if the data store catalog 220 indicates that a copy of a bucket in common storage 216 is stored in a particular search node 506, the query system 214 can assign the particular search node to the bucket. In this way, the query system 214 can reduce the likelihood that the bucket will be retrieved from common storage 216. In certain embodiments, the data store catalog 220 can store an indication that a bucket was recently downloaded to a search node 506. The query system 214 for can use this information to assign search node 506 to that bucket.
3.6. Query Acceleration Data Store
With continued reference to
In certain embodiments, the search manager 514 or search nodes 506 can store query results in the query acceleration data store 222. In some embodiments, the query results can correspond to partial results from one or more search nodes 506 or to aggregated results from all the search nodes 506 involved in a query or the search manager 514. In such embodiments, the results stored in the query acceleration data store 222 can be served at a later time to the search head 504, combined with additional results obtained from a later query, transformed or further processed by the search nodes 506 or search manager 514, etc. For example, in some cases, such as where a query does not include a termination date, the search manager 514 can store initial results in the acceleration data store 222 and update the initial results as additional results are received. At any time, the initial results, or iteratively updated results can be provided to a client device 204, transformed by the search nodes 506 or search manager 514, etc.
As described herein, a user can indicate in a query that particular datasets or results are to be stored in the query acceleration data store 222. The query can then indicate operations to be performed on the particular datasets. For subsequent queries directed to the particular datasets (e.g., queries that indicate other operations for the datasets stored in the acceleration data store 222), the search nodes 506 can obtain information directly from the query acceleration data store 222.
Additionally, since the query acceleration data store 222 can be utilized to service requests from different client devices 204, the query acceleration data store 222 can implement access controls (e.g., an access control list) with respect to the stored datasets. In this way, the stored datasets can optionally be accessible only to users associated with requests for the datasets. Optionally, a user who provides a query can indicate that one or more other users are authorized to access particular requested datasets. In this way, the other users can utilize the stored datasets, thus reducing latency associated with their queries.
In some cases, data from the intake system 210 (e.g., ingested data buffer 310, etc.) can be stored in the acceleration data store 222. In such embodiments, the data from the intake system 210 can be transformed by the search nodes 506 or combined with data in the common storage 216
Furthermore, in some cases, if the query system 214 receives a query that includes a request to process data in the query acceleration data store 222, as well as data in the common storage 216, the search manager 514 or search nodes 506 can begin processing the data in the query acceleration data store 222, while also obtaining and processing the other data from the common storage 216. In this way, the query system 214 can rapidly provide initial results for the query, while the search nodes 506 obtain and search the data from the common storage 216.
It will be understood that the data intake and query system 108 can include fewer or more components as desired. For example, in some embodiments, the system 108 does not include an acceleration data store 222. Further, it will be understood that in some embodiments, the functionality described herein for one component can be performed by another component. For example, the search master 512 and search manager 514 can be combined as one component, etc.
As described herein, the various components of the data intake and query system 108 can perform a variety of functions associated with the intake, indexing, storage, and querying of data from a variety of sources. It will be understood that any one or any combination of the functions described herein can be combined as part of a single routine or method. For example, a routine can include any one or any combination of one or more data ingestion functions, one or more indexing functions, and/or one or more searching functions.
4.1 Ingestion
As discussed above, ingestion into the data intake and query system 108 can be facilitated by an intake system 210, which functions to process data according to a streaming data model, and make the data available as messages on an output ingestion buffer 310, categorized according to a number of potential topics. Messages may be published to the output ingestion buffer 310 by streaming data processors 308, based on preliminary processing of messages published to an intake ingestion buffer 306. The intake ingestion buffer 306 is, in turn, populated with messages by one or more publishers, each of which may represent an intake point for the data intake and query system 108. The publishers may collectively implement a data retrieval subsystem 304 for the data intake and query system 108, which subsystem 304 functions to retrieve data from a data source 202 and publish the data in the form of a message on the intake ingestion buffer 306. A flow diagram depicting an illustrative embodiment for processing data at the intake system 210 is shown at
4.1.1 Publication to Intake Topic(s)
As shown in
As discussed above, the data retrieval subsystem 304 may generate the message based on data received from a forwarder 302 and/or from one or more data sources 202. In some instances, generation of a message may include converting a format of the data into a format suitable for publishing on the intake ingestion buffer 306. Generation of a message may further include determining a topic for the message. In one embodiment, the data retrieval subsystem 304 selects a topic based on a data source 202 from which the data is received, or based on the specific publisher (e.g., intake point) on which the message is generated. For example, each data source 202 or specific publisher may be associated with a particular topic on the intake ingestion buffer 306 to which corresponding messages are published. In some instances, the same source data may be used to generate multiple messages to the intake ingestion buffer 306 (e.g., associated with different topics).
4.1.2 Transmission to Streaming Data Processors
After receiving a message from a publisher, the intake ingestion buffer 306, at (2), determines subscribers to the topic. For the purposes of example, it will be associated that at least one device of the streaming data processors 308 has subscribed to the topic (e.g., by previously transmitting to the intake ingestion buffer 306 a subscription request). As noted above, the streaming data processors 308 may be implemented by a number of (logically or physically) distinct devices. As such, the streaming data processors 308, at (2), may operate to determine which devices of the streaming data processors 308 have subscribed to the topic (or topics) to which the message was published.
Thereafter, at (3), the intake ingestion buffer 306 publishes the message to the streaming data processors 308 in accordance with the pub-sub model. This publication may correspond to a “push” model of communication, whereby an ingestion buffer determines topic subscribers and initiates transmission of messages within the topic to the subscribers. While interactions of
4.1.3 Messages Processing
On receiving a message, the streaming data processors 308, at (4), analyze the message to determine one or more rules applicable to the message. As noted above, rules maintained at the streaming data processors 308 can generally include selection criteria indicating messages to which the rule applies. This selection criteria may be formatted in the same manner or similarly to extraction rules, discussed in more detail below, and may include any number or combination of criteria based on the data included within a message or metadata of the message, such as regular expressions based on the data or metadata.
On determining that a rule is applicable to the message, the streaming data processors 308 can apply to the message one or more processing sub-rules indicated within the rule. Processing sub-rules may include modifying data or metadata of the message. Illustratively, processing sub-rules may edit or normalize data of the message (e.g., to convert a format of the data) or inject additional information into the message (e.g., retrieved based on the data of the message). For example, a processing sub-rule may specify that the data of the message be transformed according to a transformation algorithmically specified within the sub-rule. Thus, at (5), the streaming data processors 308 applies the sub-rule to transform the data of the message.
In addition or alternatively, processing sub-rules can specify a destination of the message after the message is processed at the streaming data processors 308. The destination may include, for example, a specific ingestion buffer (e.g., intake ingestion buffer 306, output ingestion buffer 310, etc.) to which the message should be published, as well as the topic on the ingestion buffer to which the message should be published. For example, a particular rule may state that messages including metrics within a first format (e.g., imperial units) should have their data transformed into a second format (e.g., metric units) and be republished to the intake ingestion buffer 306. At such, at (6), the streaming data processors 308 can determine a target ingestion buffer and topic for the transformed message based on the rule determined to apply to the message. Thereafter, the streaming data processors 308 publishes the message to the destination buffer and topic.
For the purposes of illustration, the interactions of
It is assumed for the purposes of these illustrative interactions that at least one device implementing the streaming data processors 308 has subscribed to the topic to which the transformed message is published. Thus, the streaming data processors 308 is expected to again receive the message (e.g., as previously transformed the streaming data processors 308), determine whether any rules apply to the message, and process the message in accordance with one or more applicable rules. In this manner, interactions (2) through (8) may occur repeatedly, as designated in
After completion of the iterative processing loop 602, the interactions of
In other instances, a single message published to the intake ingestion buffer 306 may spawn multiple processing paths at the streaming data processors 308. Illustratively, the streaming data processors 308 may be configured to maintain a set of rules, and to independently apply to a message all rules applicable to the message. Each application of a rule may spawn an independent processing path, and potentially a new message for publication to a relevant ingestion buffer. In other instances, the streaming data processors 308 may maintain a ranking of rules to be applied to messages, and may be configured to process only a highest ranked rule which applies to the message. Thus, a single message on the intake ingestion buffer 306 may result in a single message or multiple messages published by the streaming data processors 308, according to the configuration of the streaming data processors 308 in applying rules.
As noted above, the rules applied by the streaming data processors 308 may vary during operation of those processors 308. For example, the rules may be updated as user queries are received (e.g., to identify messages whose data is relevant to those queries). In some instances, rules of the streaming data processors 308 may be altered during the processing of a message, and thus the interactions of
While the rules above are described as making various illustrative alterations to messages, various other alterations are possible within the present disclosure. For example, rules in some instances be used to remove data from messages, or to alter the structure of the messages to conform to the format requirements of a downstream system or component. Removal of information may be beneficial, for example, where the messages include private, personal, or confidential information which is unneeded or should not be made available by a downstream system. In some instances, removal of information may include replacement of the information with a less confidential value. For example, a mailing address may be considered confidential information, whereas a postal code may not be. Thus, a rule may be implemented at the streaming data processors 308 to replace mailing addresses with a corresponding postal code, to ensure confidentiality. Various other alterations will be apparent in view of the present disclosure.
4.1.4 Transmission to Subscribers
As discussed above, the rules applied by the streaming data processors 308 may eventually cause a message containing data from a data source 202 to be published to a topic on an output ingestion buffer 310, which topic may be specified, for example, by the rule applied by the streaming data processors 308. The output ingestion buffer 310 may thereafter make the message available to downstream systems or components. These downstream systems or components are generally referred to herein as “subscribers.” For example, the indexing system 212 may subscribe to an indexing topic 342, the query system 214 may subscribe to a search results topic 348, a client device 102 may subscribe to a custom topic 352A, etc. In accordance with the pub-sub model, the output ingestion buffer 310 may transmit each message published to a topic to each subscriber of that topic, and resiliently store the messages until acknowledged by each subscriber (or potentially until an error is logged with respect to a subscriber). As noted above, other models of communication are possible and contemplated within the present disclosure. For example, rather than subscribing to a topic on the output ingestion buffer 310 and allowing the output ingestion buffer 310 to initiate transmission of messages to the subscriber 602, the output ingestion buffer 310 may be configured to allow a subscriber 602 to query the buffer 310 for messages (e.g., unread messages, new messages since last transmission, etc.), and to initiate transmission of those messages form the buffer 310 to the subscriber 602. In some instances, such querying may remove the need for the subscriber 602 to separately “subscribe” to the topic.
Accordingly, at (16), after receiving a message to a topic, the output ingestion buffer 310 determines the subscribers to the topic (e.g., based on prior subscription requests transmitted to the output ingestion buffer 310). At (17), the output ingestion buffer 310 transmits the message to a subscriber 602. Thereafter, the subscriber may process the message at (18). Illustrative examples of such processing are described below, and may include (for example) preparation of search results for a client device 204, indexing of the data at the indexing system 212, and the like. After processing, the subscriber can acknowledge the message to the output ingestion buffer 310, thus confirming that the message has been processed at the subscriber.
4.1.5 Data Resiliency and Security
In accordance with embodiments of the present disclosure, the interactions of
For example, as shown in
Similarly, as shown in
While message acknowledgement is described herein as an illustrative mechanism to ensure data resiliency at an intake system 210, other mechanisms for ensuring data resiliency may additionally or alternatively be used.
As will be appreciated in view of the present disclosure, the configuration and operation of the intake system 210 can further provide high amounts of security to the messages of that system. Illustratively, the intake ingestion buffer 306 or output ingestion buffer 310 may maintain an authorization record indicating specific devices or systems with authorization to publish or subscribe to a specific topic on the ingestion buffer. As such, an ingestion buffer may ensure that only authorized parties are able to access sensitive data. In some instances, this security may enable multiple entities to utilize the intake system 210 to manage confidential information, with little or no risk of that information being shared between the entities. The managing of data or processing for multiple entities is in some instances referred to as “multi-tenancy.”
Illustratively, a first entity may publish messages to a first topic on the intake ingestion buffer 306, and the intake ingestion buffer 306 may verify that any intake point or data source 202 publishing to that first topic be authorized by the first entity to do so. The streaming data processors 308 may maintain rules specific to the first entity, which the first entity may illustrative provide through authenticated session on an interface (e.g., GUI, API, command line interface (CLI), etc.). The rules of the first entity may specify one or more entity-specific topics on the output ingestion buffer 310 to which messages containing data of the first entity should be published by the streaming data processors 308. The output ingestion buffer 310 may maintain authorization records for such entity-specific topics, thus restricting messages of those topics to parties authorized by the first entity. In this manner, data security for the first entity can be ensured across the intake system 210. Similar operations may be performed for other entities, thus allowing multiple entities to separately and confidentially publish data to and retrieve data from the intake system.
4.1.6 Message Processing Algorithm
With reference to
At block 704, the intake system 210 obtains a message at the intake ingestion buffer 306. The message may be published to the intake ingestion buffer 306, for example, by the data retrieval subsystem 304 (e.g., working in conjunction with a forwarder 302) and reflect data obtained from a data source 202.
At block 706, the intake system 210 determines whether any obtained rule applies to the message. Illustratively, the intake system 210 (e.g., via the streaming data processors 308) may apply selection criteria of each rule to the message to determine whether the message satisfies the selection criteria. Thereafter, the routine varies according to whether a rule applies to the message. If no rule applies, the routine can continue to block 714, where the intake system 210 transmits an acknowledgement for the message to the intake ingestion buffer 306, thus enabling the buffer 306 to discard the message (e.g., once all other subscribers have acknowledged the message). In some variations of the routine, a “default rule” may be applied at the intake system 210, such that all messages are processed as least according to the default rule. The default rule may, for example, forward the message to an indexing topic 342 for processing by an indexing system 212. In such a configuration, block 706 may always evaluate as true.
In the instance that at least one rule is determined to apply to the message, the routine continues to block 708, where the intake system 210 (e.g., via the streaming data processors 308) transforms the message as specified by the applicable rule. For example, a processing sub-rule of the applicable rule may specify that data or metadata of the message be converted from one format to another via an algorithmic transformation. As such, the intake system 210 may apply the algorithmic transformation to the data or metadata of the message at block 708 to transform the data or metadata of the message. In some instances, no transformation may be specified within intake system 210, and thus block 708 may be omitted.
At block 710, the intake system 210 determines a destination ingestion buffer to which to publish the (potentially transformed) message, as well as a topic to which the message should be published. The destination ingestion buffer and topic may be specified, for example, in processing sub-rules of the rule determined to apply to the message. In one embodiment, the destination ingestion buffer and topic may vary according to the data or metadata of the message. In another embodiment, the destination ingestion buffer and topic may be fixed with respect to a particular rule.
At block 712, the intake system 210 publishes the (potentially transformed) message to the determined destination ingestion buffer and topic. The determined destination ingestion buffer may be, for example, the intake ingestion buffer 306 or the output ingestion buffer 310. Thereafter, at block 714, the intake system 210 acknowledges the initial message on the intake ingestion buffer 306, thus enabling the intake ingestion buffer 306 to delete the message.
Thereafter, the routine returns to block 704, where the intake system 210 continues to process messages from the intake ingestion buffer 306. Because the destination ingestion buffer determined during a prior implementation of the routine may be the intake ingestion buffer 306, the routine may continue to process the same underlying data within multiple messages published on that buffer 306 (thus implementing an iterative processing loop with respect to that data). The routine may then continue to be implemented during operation of the intake system 210, such that data published to the intake ingestion buffer 306 is processed by the intake system 210 and made available on an output ingestion buffer 310 to downstream systems or components.
While the routine of
While the routine of
4.2. Indexing
At (1), the indexing node manager 406 activates a partition manager 408 for a partition. As described herein, the indexing node manager 406 can activate a partition manager 408 for each partition or shard that is processed by an indexing node 404. In some embodiments, the indexing node manager 406 can activate the partition manager 408 based on an assignment of a new partition to the indexing node 404 or a partition manager 408 becoming unresponsive or unavailable, etc.
In some embodiments, the partition manager 408 can be a copy of the indexing node manager 406 or a copy of a template process. In certain embodiments, the partition manager 408 can be instantiated in a separate container from the indexing node manager 406.
At (2), the ingestion buffer 310 sends data and a buffer location to the indexing node 212. As described herein, the data can be raw machine data, performance metrics data, correlation data, JSON blobs, XML data, data in a datamodel, report data, tabular data, streaming data, data exposed in an API, data in a relational database, etc. The buffer location can correspond to a marker in the ingestion buffer 310 that indicates the point at which the data within a partition has been communicated to the indexing node 404. For example, data before the marker can correspond to data that has not been communicated to the indexing node 404, and data after the marker can correspond to data that has been communicated to the indexing node. In some cases, the marker can correspond to a set of data that has been communicated to the indexing node 404, but for which no indication has been received that the data has been stored. Accordingly, based on the marker, the ingestion buffer 310 can retain a portion of its data persistently until it receives confirmation that the data can be deleted or has been stored in common storage 216.
At (3), the indexing node manager 406 tracks the buffer location and the partition manager 408 communicates the data to the indexer 410. As described herein, the indexing node manager 406 can track (and/or store) the buffer location for the various partitions received from the ingestion buffer 310. In addition, as described herein, the partition manager 408 can forward the data received from the ingestion buffer 310 to the indexer 410 for processing. In various implementations, as previously described, the data from ingestion buffer 310 that is sent to the indexer 410 may include a path to stored data, e.g., data stored in common store 216 or another common store, which is then retrieved by the indexer 410 or another component of the indexing node 404.
At (4), the indexer 410 processes the data. As described herein, the indexer 410 can perform a variety of functions, enrichments, or transformations on the data as it is indexed. For example, the indexer 410 can parse the data, identify events from the data, identify and associate timestamps with the events, associate metadata or one or more field values with the events, group events (e.g., based on time, partition, and/or tenant ID, etc.), etc. Furthermore, the indexer 410 can generate buckets based on a bucket creation policy and store the events in the hot buckets, which may be stored in data store 412 of the indexing node 404 associated with that indexer 410 (see
At (5), the indexer 410 reports the size of the data being indexed to the partition manager 408. In some cases, the indexer 410 can routinely provide a status update to the partition manager 408 regarding the data that is being processed by the indexer 410.
The status update can include, but is not limited to the size of the data, the number of buckets being created, the amount of time since the buckets have been created, etc. In some embodiments, the indexer 410 can provide the status update based on one or more thresholds being satisfied (e.g., one or more threshold sizes being satisfied by the amount of data being processed, one or more timing thresholds being satisfied based on the amount of time the buckets have been created, one or more bucket number thresholds based on the number of buckets created, the number of hot or warm buckets, number of buckets that have not been stored in common storage 216, etc.).
In certain cases, the indexer 410 can provide an update to the partition manager 408 regarding the size of the data that is being processed by the indexer 410 in response to one or more threshold sizes being satisfied. For example, each time a certain amount of data is added to the indexer 410 (e.g., 5 MB, 10 MB, etc.), the indexer 410 can report the updated size to the partition manager 408. In some cases, the indexer 410 can report the size of the data stored thereon to the partition manager 408 once a threshold size is satisfied.
In certain embodiments, the indexer 410 reports the size of the date being indexed to the partition manager 408 based on a query by the partition manager 408. In certain embodiments, the indexer 410 and partition manager 408 maintain an open communication link such that the partition manager 408 is persistently aware of the amount of data on the indexer 410.
In some cases, a partition manager 408 monitors the data processed by the indexer 410. For example, the partition manager 408 can track the size of the data on the indexer 410 that is associated with the partition being managed by the partition manager 408. In certain cases, one or more partition managers 408 can track the amount or size of the data on the indexer 410 that is associated with any partition being managed by the indexing node manager 406 or that is associated with the indexing node 404.
At (6), the partition manager 408 instructs the indexer 410 to copy the data to common storage 216. As described herein, the partition manager 408 can instruct the indexer 410 to copy the data to common storage 216 based on a bucket roll-over policy. As described herein, in some cases, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that one or more buckets are to be rolled over based on size. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the partition manager 408 can instruct the indexer 410 to copy the data to common storage 216 based on a determination that the amount of data stored on the indexer 410 satisfies a threshold amount. The threshold amount can correspond to the amount of data associated with the partition that is managed by the partition manager 408 or the amount of data being processed by the indexer 410 for any partition.
In some cases, the partition manager 408 can instruct the indexer 410 to copy the data that corresponds to the partition being managed by the partition manager 408 to common storage 216 based on the size of the data that corresponds to the partition satisfying the threshold amount. In certain embodiments, the partition manager 408 can instruct the indexer 410 to copy the data associated with any partition being processed by the indexer 410 to common storage 216 based on the amount of the data from the partitions that are being processed by the indexer 410 satisfying the threshold amount.
In some embodiments, (5) and/or (6) can be omitted. For example, the indexer 410 can monitor the data stored thereon. Based on the bucket roll-over policy, the indexer 410 can determine that the data is to be copied to common storage 216. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the indexer 410 can determine that the data is to be copied to common storage 216 without communication with the partition manager 408.
At (7), the indexer 410 copies and/or stores the data to common storage 216. As described herein, in some cases, as the indexer 410 processes the data, it generates events and stores the events in hot buckets. In response to receiving the instruction to move the data to common storage 216, the indexer 410 can convert the hot buckets to warm buckets, and copy or move the warm buckets to the common storage 216.
As part of storing the data to common storage 216, the indexer 410 can verify or obtain acknowledgements that the data is stored successfully. In some embodiments, the indexer 410 can determine information regarding the data stored in the common storage 216. For example, the information can include location information regarding the data that was stored to the common storage 216, bucket identifiers of the buckets that were copied to common storage 216, as well as additional information, e.g., in implementations in which the ingestion buffer 310 uses sequences of records as the form for data storage, the list of record sequence numbers that were used as part of those buckets that were copied to common storage 216.
At (8), the indexer 410 reports or acknowledges to the partition manager 408 that the data is stored in the common storage 216. In various implementations, this can be in response to periodic requests from the partition manager 408 to the indexer 410 regarding which buckets and/or data have been stored to common storage 216. The indexer 410 can provide the partition manager 408 with information regarding the data stored in common storage 216 similar to the data that is provided to the indexer 410 by the common storage 216. In some cases, (8) can be replaced with the common storage 216 acknowledging or reporting the storage of the data to the partition manager 408.
At (9), the partition manager 408 updates the data store catalog 220. As described herein, the partition manager 408 can update the data store catalog 220 with information regarding the data or buckets stored in common storage 216. For example, the partition manager 408 can update the data store catalog 220 to include location information, a bucket identifier, a time range, and tenant and partition information regarding the buckets copied to common storage 216, etc. In this way, the data store catalog 220 can include up-to-date information regarding the buckets stored in common storage 216.
At (10), the partition manager 408 reports the completion of the storage to the ingestion buffer 310, and at (11), the ingestion buffer 310 updates the buffer location or marker. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the ingestion buffer 310 can maintain its marker until it receives an acknowledgement that the data that it sent to the indexing node 404 has been indexed by the indexing node 404 and stored to common storage 216. In addition, the updated buffer location or marker can be communicated to and stored by the indexing node manager 406. In this way, a data intake and query system 108 can use the ingestion buffer 310 to provide a stateless environment for the indexing system 212. For example, as described herein, if an indexing node 404 or one of its components (e.g., indexing node manager 486, partition manager 408, indexer) becomes unavailable or unresponsive before data from the ingestion buffer 310 is copied to common storage 216, the indexing system 212 can generate or assign a new indexing node 404 (or component), to process the data that was assigned to the now unavailable indexing node 404 (or component) while reducing, minimizing, or eliminating data loss.
At (12), a bucket manager 414, which may form part of the indexer 410, the indexing node 404, or indexing system 212, merges multiple buckets into one or more merged buckets. As described herein, to reduce delay between processing data and making that data available for searching, the indexer 410 can convert smaller hot buckets to warm buckets and copy the warm buckets to common storage 216. However, as smaller buckets in common storage 216 can result in increased overhead and storage costs, the bucket manager 414 can monitor warm buckets in the indexer 410 and merge the warm buckets into one or more merged buckets.
In some cases, the bucket manager 414 can merge the buckets according to a bucket merge policy. As described herein, the bucket merge policy can indicate which buckets are candidates for a merge (e.g., based on time ranges, size, tenant/partition or other identifiers, etc.), the number of buckets to merge, size or time range parameters for the merged buckets, a frequency for creating the merged buckets, etc.
At (13), the bucket manager 414 stores and/or copies the merged data or buckets to common storage 216, and obtains information about the merged buckets stored in common storage 216. Similar to (7), the obtained information can include information regarding the storage of the merged buckets, such as, but not limited to, the location of the buckets, one or more bucket identifiers, tenant or partition identifiers, etc. At (14), the bucket manager 414 reports the storage of the merged data to the partition manager 408, similar to the reporting of the data storage at (8).
At (15), the indexer 410 deletes data from the data store (e.g., data store 412). As described herein, once the merged buckets have been stored in common storage 216, the indexer 410 can delete corresponding buckets that it has stored locally. For example, the indexer 410 can delete the merged buckets from the data store 412, as well as the pre-merged buckets (buckets used to generate the merged buckets). By removing the data from the data store 412, the indexer 410 can free up additional space for additional hot buckets, warm buckets, and/or merged buckets.
At (16), the common storage 216 deletes data according to a bucket management policy. As described herein, once the merged buckets have been stored in common storage 216, the common storage 216 can delete the pre-merged buckets stored therein. In some cases, as described herein, the common storage 216 can delete the pre-merged buckets immediately, after a predetermined amount of time, after one or more queries relying on the pre-merged buckets have completed, or based on other criteria in the bucket management policy, etc. In certain embodiments, a controller at the common storage 216 handles the deletion of the data in common storage 216 according to the bucket management policy. In certain embodiments, one or more components of the indexing node 404 delete the data from common storage 216 according to the bucket management policy. However, for simplicity, reference is made to common storage 216 performing the deletion.
At (17), the partition manager 408 updates the data store catalog 220 with the information about the merged buckets. Similar to (9), the partition manager 408 can update the data store catalog 220 with the merged bucket information. The information can include, but is not limited to, the time range of the merged buckets, location of the merged buckets in common storage 216, a bucket identifier for the merged buckets, tenant and partition information of the merged buckets, etc. In addition, as part of updating the data store catalog 220, the partition manager 408 can remove reference to the pre-merged buckets. Accordingly, the data store catalog 220 can be revised to include information about the merged buckets and omit information about the pre-merged buckets. In this way, as the search managers 514 request information about buckets in common storage 216 from the data store catalog 220, the data store catalog 220 can provide the search managers 514 with the merged bucket information.
As mentioned previously, in some of embodiments, one or more of the functions described herein with respect to
4.2.1. Containerized Indexing Nodes
At block 902, the indexing system 212 receives data. As described herein, the system 312 can receive data from a variety of sources in various formats. For example, as described herein, the data received can be machine data, performance metrics, correlated data, etc.
At block 904, the indexing system 212 stores the data in buckets using one or more containerized indexing nodes 404. As described herein, the indexing system 212 can include multiple containerized indexing nodes 404 to receive and process the data. The containerized indexing nodes 404 can enable the indexing system 212 to provide a highly extensible and dynamic indexing service. For example, based on resource availability and/or workload, the indexing system 212 can instantiate additional containerized indexing nodes 404 or terminate containerized indexing nodes 404. Further, multiple containerized indexing nodes 404 can be instantiated on the same computing device, and share the resources of the computing device.
As described herein, each indexing node 404 can be implemented using containerization or operating-system-level virtualization, or other virtualization technique. For example, the indexing node 404, or one or more components of the indexing node 404 can be implemented as separate containers or container instances. Each container instance can have certain resources (e.g., memory, processor, etc.) of the underlying computing system assigned to it, but may share the same operating system and may use the operating system's system call interface. Further, each container may run the same or different computer applications concurrently or separately, and may interact with each other. It will be understood that other virtualization techniques can be used. For example, the containerized indexing nodes 404 can be implemented using virtual machines using full virtualization or paravirtualization, etc.
In some embodiments, the indexing node 404 can be implemented as a group of related containers or a pod, and the various components of the indexing node 404 can be implemented as related containers of a pod. Further, the indexing node 404 can assign different containers to execute different tasks. For example, one container of a containerized indexing node 404 can receive the incoming data and forward it to a second container for processing, etc. The second container can generate buckets for the data, store the data in buckets, and communicate the buckets to common storage 216. A third container of the containerized indexing node 404 can merge the buckets into merged buckets and store the merged buckets in common storage. However, it will be understood that the containerized indexing node 404 can be implemented in a variety of configurations. For example, in some cases, the containerized indexing node 404 can be implemented as a single container and can include multiple processes to implement the tasks described above by the three containers. Any combination of containerization and processed can be used to implement the containerized indexing node 404 as desired.
In some embodiments, the containerized indexing node 404 processes the received data (or the data obtained using the received data) and stores it in buckets. As part of the processing, the containerized indexing node 404 can determine information about the data (e.g., host, source, sourcetype), extract or identify timestamps, associated metadata fields with the data, extract keywords, transform the data, identify and organize the data into events having raw machine data associated with a timestamp, etc. In some embodiments, the containerized indexing node 404 uses one or more configuration files and/or extraction rules to extract information from the data or events.
In addition, as part of processing and storing the data, the containerized indexing node 404 can generate buckets for the data according to a bucket creation policy. As described herein, the containerized indexing node 404 can concurrently generate and fill multiple buckets with the data that it processes. In some embodiments, the containerized indexing node 404 generates buckets for each partition or tenant associated with the data that is being processed. In certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 stores the data or events in the buckets based on the identified timestamps.
Furthermore, containerized indexing node 404 can generate one or more indexes associated with the buckets, such as, but not limited to, one or more inverted indexes, TSIDXs, keyword indexes, etc. The data and the indexes can be stored in one or more files of the buckets. In addition, the indexing node 404 can generate additional files for the buckets, such as, but not limited to, one or more filter files, a bucket summary, or manifest, etc.
At block 906, the indexing node 404 stores buckets in common storage 216. As described herein, in certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 stores the buckets in common storage 216 according to a bucket roll-over policy. In some cases, the buckets are stored in common storage 216 in one or more directories based on an index/partition or tenant associated with the buckets. Further, the buckets can be stored in a time series manner to facilitate time series searching as described herein. Additionally, as described herein, the common storage 216 can replicate the buckets across multiple tiers and data stores across one or more geographical locations.
Fewer, more, or different blocks can be used as part of the routine 900. In some cases, one or more blocks can be omitted. For example, in some embodiments, the containerized indexing node 404 or a indexing system manager 402 can monitor the amount of data received by the indexing system 212. Based on the amount of data received and/or a workload or utilization of the containerized indexing node 404, the indexing system 212 can instantiate an additional containerized indexing node 404 to process the data.
In some cases, the containerized indexing node 404 can instantiate a container or process to manage the processing and storage of data from an additional shard or partition of data received from the intake system. For example, as described herein, the containerized indexing node 404 can instantiate a partition manager 408 for each partition or shard of data that is processed by the containerized indexing node 404.
In certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 can delete locally stored buckets. For example, once the buckets are stored in common storage 216, the indexing node 404 can delete the locally stored buckets. In this way, the indexing node 404 can reduce the amount of data stored thereon.
As described herein, the indexing node 404 can merge buckets and store merged buckets in the common storage 216. In some cases, as part of merging and storing buckets in common storage 216, the indexing node 404 can delete locally storage pre-merged buckets (buckets used to generate the merged buckets) and/or the merged buckets or can instruct the common storage 216 to delete the pre-merged buckets. In this way, the indexing node 404 can reduce the amount of data stored in the indexing node 404 and/or the amount of data stored in common storage 216.
In some embodiments, the indexing node 404 can update a data store catalog 220 with information about pre-merged or merged buckets stored in common storage 216. As described herein, the information can identify the location of the buckets in common storage 216 and other information, such as, but not limited to, a partition or tenant associated with the bucket, time range of the bucket, etc. As described herein, the information stored in the data store catalog 220 can be used by the query system 214 to identify buckets to be searched as part of a query.
Furthermore, it will be understood that the various blocks described herein with reference to
4.2.2. Moving Buckets to Common Storage
At block 1002, the indexing node 404 receives data. As described herein, the indexing node 404 can receive data from a variety of sources in various formats. For example, as described herein, the data received can be machine data, performance metrics, correlated data, etc.
Further, as described herein, the indexing node 404 can receive data from one or more components of the intake system 210 (e.g., the ingesting buffer 310, forwarder 302, etc.) or other data sources 202. In some embodiments, the indexing node 404 can receive data from a shard or partition of the ingestion buffer 310. Further, in certain cases, the indexing node 404 can generate a partition manager 408 for each shard or partition of a data stream. In some cases, the indexing node 404 receives data from the ingestion buffer 310 that references or points to data stored in one or more data stores, such as a data store 218 of common storage 216, or other network accessible data store or cloud storage. In such embodiments, the indexing node 404 can obtain the data from the referenced data store using the information received from the ingestion buffer 310.
At block 1004, the indexing node 404 stores data in buckets. In some embodiments, the indexing node 404 processes the received data (or the data obtained using the received data) and stores it in buckets. As part of the processing, the indexing node 404 can determine information about the data (e.g., host, source, sourcetype), extract or identify timestamps, associated metadata fields with the data, extract keywords, transform the data, identify and organize the data into events having raw machine data associated with a timestamp, etc. In some embodiments, the indexing node 404 uses one or more configuration files and/or extraction rules to extract information from the data or events.
In addition, as part of processing and storing the data, the indexing node 404 can generate buckets for the data according to a bucket creation policy. As described herein, the indexing node 404 can concurrently generate and fill multiple buckets with the data that it processes. In some embodiments, the indexing node 404 generates buckets for each partition or tenant associated with the data that is being processed. In certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 stores the data or events in the buckets based on the identified timestamps.
Furthermore, indexing node 404 can generate one or more indexes associated with the buckets, such as, but not limited to, one or more inverted indexes, TSIDXs, keyword indexes, bloom filter files, etc. The data and the indexes can be stored in one or more files of the buckets. In addition, the indexing node 404 can generate additional files for the buckets, such as, but not limited to, one or more filter files, buckets summary, or manifest, etc.
At block 1006, the indexing node 404 monitors the buckets. As described herein, the indexing node 404 can process significant amounts of data across a multitude of buckets, and can monitor the size or amount of data stored in individual buckets, groups of buckets or all the buckets that it is generating and filling. In certain embodiments, one component of the indexing node 404 can monitor the buckets (e.g., partition manager 408), while another component fills the buckets (e.g., indexer 410).
In some embodiments, as part of monitoring the buckets, the indexing node 404 can compare the individual size of the buckets or the collective size of multiple buckets with a threshold size. Once the threshold size is satisfied, the indexing node 404 can determine that the buckets are to be stored in common storage 216. In certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 can monitor the amount of time that has passed since the buckets have been stored in common storage 216. Based on a determination that a threshold amount of time has passed, the indexing node 404 can determine that the buckets are to be stored in common storage 216. Further, it will be understood that the indexing node 404 can use a bucket roll-over policy and/or a variety of techniques to determine when to store buckets in common storage 216.
At block 1008, the indexing node 404 converts the buckets. In some cases, as part of preparing the buckets for storage in common storage 216, the indexing node 404 can convert the buckets from editable buckets to non-editable buckets. In some cases, the indexing node 404 convert hot buckets to warm buckets based on the bucket roll-over policy. The bucket roll-over policy can indicate that buckets are to be converted from hot to warm buckets based on a predetermined period of time, one or more buckets satisfying a threshold size, the number of hot buckets, etc. In some cases, based on the bucket roll-over policy, the indexing node 404 converts hot buckets to warm buckets based on a collective size of multiple hot buckets satisfying a threshold size. The multiple hot buckets can correspond to any one or any combination of randomly selected hot buckets, hot buckets associated with a particular partition or shard (or partition manager 408), hot buckets associated with a particular tenant or partition, all hot buckets in the data store 412 or being processed by the indexer 410, etc.
At block 1010, the indexing node 404 stores the converted buckets in a data store. As described herein, the indexing node 404 can store the buckets in common storage 216 or other location accessible to the query system 214. In some cases, the indexing node 404 stores a copy of the buckets in common storage 416 and retains the original bucket in its data store 412. In certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 stores a copy of the buckets in common storage and deletes any reference to the original buckets in its data store 412.
Furthermore, as described herein, in some cases, the indexing node 404 can store the one or more buckets based on the bucket roll-over policy. In addition to indicating when buckets are to be converted from hot buckets to warm buckets, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate when buckets are to be stored in common storage 216. In some cases, the bucket roll-over policy can use the same or different policies or thresholds to indicate when hot buckets are to be converted to warm and when buckets are to be stored in common storage 216.
In certain embodiments, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that buckets are to be stored in common storage 216 based on a collective size of buckets satisfying a threshold size. As mentioned, the threshold size used to determine that the buckets are to be stored in common storage 216 can be the same as or different from the threshold size used to determine that editable buckets should be converted to non-editable buckets. Accordingly, in certain embodiments, based on a determination that the size of the one or more buckets have satisfied a threshold size, the indexing node 404 can convert the buckets to non-editable buckets and store the buckets in common storage 216.
Other thresholds and/or other factors or combinations of thresholds and factors can be used as part of the bucket roll-over policy. For example, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that buckets are to be stored in common storage 216 based on the passage of a threshold amount of time. As yet another example, bucket roll-over policy can indicate that buckets are to be stored in common storage 216 based on the number of buckets satisfying a threshold number.
It will be understood that the bucket roll-over policy can use a variety of techniques or thresholds to indicate when to store the buckets in common storage 216. For example, in some cases, the bucket roll-over policy can use any one or any combination of a threshold time period, threshold number of buckets, user information, tenant or partition information, query frequency, amount of data being received, time of day or schedules, etc., to indicate when buckets are to be stored in common storage 216 (and/or converted to non-editable buckets). In some cases, the bucket roll-over policy can use different priorities to determine how to store the buckets, such as, but not limited to, minimizing or reducing time between processing and storage to common storage 216, maximizing or increasing individual bucket size, etc. Furthermore, the bucket roll-over policy can use dynamic thresholds to indicate when buckets are to be stored in common storage 216.
As mentioned, in some cases, based on an increased query frequency, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that buckets are to be moved to common storage 216 more frequently by adjusting one more thresholds used to determine when the buckets are to be stored to common storage 216 (e.g., threshold size, threshold number, threshold time, etc.).
In addition, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that different sets of buckets are to be rolled-over differently or at different rates or frequencies. For example, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that buckets associated with a first tenant or partition are to be rolled over according to one policy and buckets associated with a second tenant or partition are to be rolled over according to a different policy. The different policies may indicate that the buckets associated with the first tenant or partition are to be stored more frequently to common storage 216 than the buckets associated with the second tenant or partition. Accordingly, the bucket roll-over policy can use one set of thresholds (e.g., threshold size, threshold number, and/or threshold time, etc.) to indicate when the buckets associated with the first tenant or partition are to be stored in common storage 216 and a different set of thresholds for the buckets associated with the second tenant or partition.
As another non-limiting example, consider a scenario in which buckets from a partition _main are being queried more frequently than bucket from the partition _test. The bucket roll-over policy can indicate that based on the increased frequency of queries for buckets from partition main, buckets associated with partition _main should be moved more frequently to common storage 216, for example, by adjusting the threshold size used to determine when to store the buckets in common storage 216. In this way, the query system 214 can obtain relevant search results more quickly for data associated with the _main partition. Further, if the frequency of queries for buckets from the _main partition decreases, the data intake and query system 108 can adjust the threshold accordingly. In addition, the bucket roll-over policy may indicate that the changes are only for buckets associated with the partition _main or that the changes are to be made for all buckets, or all buckets associated with a particular tenant that is associated with the partition _main, etc.
Furthermore, as mentioned, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that buckets are to be stored in common storage 216 at different rates or frequencies based on time of day. For example, the data intake and query system 108 can adjust the thresholds so that the buckets are moved to common storage 216 more frequently during working hours and less frequently during non-working hours. In this way, the delay between processing and making the data available for searching during working hours can be reduced, and can decrease the amount of merging performed on buckets generated during non-working hours. In other cases, the data intake and query system 108 can adjust the thresholds so that the buckets are moved to common storage 216 less frequently during working hours and more frequently during non-working hours.
As mentioned, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that based on an increased rate at which data is received, buckets are to be moved to common storage more (or less) frequently. For example, if the bucket roll-over policy initially indicates that the buckets are to be stored every millisecond, as the rate of data received by the indexing node 404 increases, the amount of data received during each millisecond can increase, resulting in more data waiting to be stored. As such, in some cases, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that the buckets are to be stored more frequently in common storage 216. Further, in some cases, such as when a collective bucket size threshold is used, an increased rate at which data is received may overburden the indexing node 404 due to the overhead associated with copying each bucket to common storage 216. As such, in certain cases, the bucket roll-over policy can use a larger collective bucket size threshold to indicate that the buckets are to be stored in common storage 216. In this way, the bucket roll-over policy can reduce the ratio of overhead to data being stored.
Similarly, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that certain users are to be treated differently. For example, if a particular user is logged in, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that the buckets in an indexing node 404 are to be moved to common storage 216 more or less frequently to accommodate the user's preferences, etc. Further, as mentioned, in some embodiments, the data intake and query system 108 may indicate that only those buckets associated with the user (e.g., based on tenant information, indexing information, user information, etc.) are to be stored more or less frequently.
Furthermore, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate whether, after copying buckets to common storage 216, the locally stored buckets are to be retained or discarded. In some cases, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that the buckets are to be retained for merging. In certain cases, the bucket roll-over policy can indicate that the buckets are to be discarded.
Fewer, more, or different blocks can be used as part of the routine 1000. In some cases, one or more blocks can be omitted. For example, in certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 may not convert the buckets before storing them. As another example, the routine 1000 can include notifying the data source, such as the intake system, that the buckets have been uploaded to common storage, merging buckets and uploading merged buckets to common storage, receiving identifying information about the buckets in common storage 216 and updating a data store catalog 220 with the received information, etc.
Furthermore, it will be understood that the various blocks described herein with reference to
4.2.3. Updating Location Marker in Ingestion Buffer
At block 1102, the indexing node 404 receives data. As described in greater detail above with reference to block 1002, the indexing node 404 can receive a variety of types of data from a variety of sources.
In some embodiments, the indexing node 404 receives data from an ingestion buffer 310. As described herein, the ingestion buffer 310 can operate according to a pub-sub messaging service. As such, the ingestion buffer 310 can communicate data to the indexing node 404, and also ensure that the data is available for additional reads until it receives an acknowledgement from the indexing node 404 that the data can be removed.
In some cases, the ingestion buffer 310 can use one or more read pointers or location markers to track the data that has been communicated to the indexing node 404 but that has not been acknowledged for removal. As the ingestion buffer 310 receives acknowledgments from the indexing node 404, it can update the location markers. In some cases, such as where the ingestion buffer 310 uses multiple partitions or shards to provide the data to the indexing node 404, the ingestion buffer 310 can include at least one location marker for each partition or shard. In this way, the ingestion buffer 310 can separately track the progress of the data reads in the different shards.
In certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 can receive (and/or store) the location markers in addition to or as part of the data received from the ingestion buffer 310. Accordingly, the indexing node 404 can track the location of the data in the ingestion buffer 310 that the indexing node 404 has received from the ingestion buffer 310. In this way, if an indexer 410 or partition manager 408 becomes unavailable or fails, the indexing node 404 can assign a different indexer 410 or partition manager 408 to process or manage the data from the ingestion buffer 310 and provide the indexer 410 or partition manager 408 with a location from which the indexer 410 or partition manager 408 can obtain the data.
At block 1104, the indexing node 404 stores the data in buckets. As described in greater detail above with reference to block 1004 of
At block 1106, the indexing node 404 stores buckets in common storage 216. As described herein, in certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 stores the buckets in common storage 216 according to the bucket roll-over policy. In some cases, the buckets are stored in common storage 216 in one or more directories based on an index/partition or tenant associated with the buckets. Further, the buckets can be stored in a time series manner to facilitate time series searching as described herein. Additionally, as described herein, the common storage 216 can replicate the buckets across multiple tiers and data stores across one or more geographical locations. In some cases, in response to the storage, the indexing node 404 receives an acknowledgement that the data was stored. Further, the indexing node 404 can receive information about the location of the data in common storage, one or more identifiers of the stored data, etc. The indexing node 404 can use this information to update the data store catalog 220.
At block 1108, the indexing node 404 notifies an ingestion buffer 310 that the data has been stored in common storage 216. As described herein, in some cases, the ingestion buffer 310 can retain location markers for the data that it sends to the indexing node 404. The ingestion buffer 310 can use the location markers to indicate that the data sent to the indexing node 404 is to be made persistently available to the indexing system 212 until the ingestion buffer 310 receives an acknowledgement from the indexing node 404 that the data has been stored successfully. In response to the acknowledgement, the ingestion buffer 310 can update the location marker(s) and communicate the updated location markers to the indexing node 404. The indexing node 404 can store updated location markers for use in the event one or more components of the indexing node 404 (e.g., partition manager 408, indexer 410) become unavailable or fail. In this way, the ingestion buffer 310 and the location markers can aid in providing a stateless indexing service.
Fewer, more, or different blocks can be used as part of the routine 1100. In some cases, one or more blocks can be omitted. For example, in certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 can update the data store catalog 220 with information about the buckets created by the indexing node 404 and/or stored in common storage 215, as described herein.
Furthermore, it will be understood that the various blocks described herein with reference to
4.2.4. Merging Buckets
At block 1202, the indexing node 404 stores data in buckets. As described herein, the indexing node 404 can process various types of data from a variety of sources. Further, the indexing node 404 can create one or more buckets according to a bucket creation policy and store the data in the store the data in one or more buckets. In addition, in certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 can convert hot or editable buckets to warm or non-editable buckets according to a bucket roll-over policy.
At block 1204, the indexing node 404 stores buckets in common storage 216. As described herein, the indexing node 404 can store the buckets in common storage 216 according to the bucket roll-over policy. In some cases, the buckets are stored in common storage 216 in one or more directories based on an index/partition or tenant associated with the buckets. Further, the buckets can be stored in a time series manner to facilitate time series searching as described herein. Additionally, as described herein, the common storage 216 can replicate the buckets across multiple tiers and data stores across one or more geographical locations.
At block 1206, the indexing node 404 updates the data store catalog 220. As described herein, in some cases, in response to the storage, the indexing node 404 receives an acknowledgement that the data was stored. Further, the indexing node 404 can receive information about the location of the data in common storage, one or more identifiers of the stored data, etc. The received information can be used by the indexing node 404 to update the data store catalog 220. In addition, the indexing node 404 can provide the data store catalog 220 with any one or any combination of the tenant or partition associated with the bucket, a time range of the events in the bucket, one or more metadata fields of the bucket (e.g., host, source, sourcetype, etc.), etc. In this way, the data store catalog 220 can store up-to-date information about the buckets in common storage 216. Further, this information can be used by the query system 214 to identify relevant buckets for a query.
In some cases, the indexing node 404 can update the data store catalog 220 before, after, or concurrently with storing the data to common storage 216. For example, as buckets are created by the indexing node 404, the indexing node 404 can update the data store catalog 220 with information about the created buckets, such as, but not limited to, an partition or tenant associated with the bucket, a time range or initial time (e.g., time of earliest-in-time timestamp), etc. In addition, the indexing node 404 can include an indication that the bucket is a hot bucket or editable bucket and that the contents of the bucket are not (yet) available for searching or in the common storage 216.
As the bucket is filled with events or data, the indexing node 404 can update the data store catalog 220 with additional information about the bucket (e.g., updated time range based on additional events, size of the bucket, number of events in the bucket, certain keywords or metadata from the bucket, such as, but not limited to a host, source, or sourcetype associated with different events in the bucket, etc.). Further, once the bucket is uploaded to common storage 216, the indexing node 404 can complete the entry for the bucket, such as, by providing a completed time range, location information of the bucket in common storage 216, completed keyword or metadata information as desired, etc.
The information in the data store catalog 220 can be used by the query system 214 to execute queries. In some cases, based on the information in the data store catalog 220 about buckets that are not yet available for searching, the query system 214 can wait until the data is available for searching before completing the query or inform a user that some data that may be relevant has not been processed or that the results will be updated. Further, in some cases, the query system 214 can inform the indexing system 212 about the bucket, and the indexing system 212 can cause the indexing node 404 to store the bucket in common storage 216 sooner than it otherwise would without the communication from the query system 214.
In addition, the indexing node 404 can update the data store catalog 220 with information about buckets to be merged. For example, once one or more buckets are identified for merging, the indexing node 404 can update an entry for the buckets in the data store catalog 220 indicating that they are part of a merge operation and/or will be replaced. In some cases, as part of the identification, the data store catalog 220 can provide information about the entries to the indexing node 404 for merging. As the entries may have summary information about the buckets, the indexing node 404 can use the summary information to generate a merged entry for the data store catalog 220 as opposed to generating the summary information from the merged data itself. In this way, the information from the data store catalog 220 can increase the efficiency of a merge operation by the indexing node 404.
At block 1208, the indexing node 404 merges buckets. In some embodiments, the indexing node 404 can merge buckets according to a bucket merge policy. As described herein, the bucket merge policy can indicate which buckets to merge, when to merge buckets and one or more parameters for the merged buckets (e.g., time range for the merged buckets, size of the merged buckets, etc.). For example, the bucket merge policy can indicate that only buckets associated with the same tenant identifier and/or partition can be merged. As another example, the bucket merge policy can indicate that only buckets that satisfy a threshold age (e.g., have existed or been converted to warm buckets for more than a set period of time) are eligible for a merge. Similarly, the bucket merge policy can indicate that each merged bucket must be at least 750 MB or no greater than 1 GB, or cannot have a time range that exceeds a predetermined amount or is larger than 75% of other buckets. The other buckets can refer to one or more buckets in common storage 216 or similar buckets (e.g., buckets associated with the same tenant, partition, host, source, or sourcetype, etc.). In certain cases, the bucket merge policy can indicate that buckets are to be merged based on a schedule (e.g., during non-working hours) or user login (e.g., when a particular user is not logged in), etc. In certain embodiments, the bucket merge policy can indicate that bucket merges can be adjusted dynamically. For example, based on the rate of incoming data or queries, the bucket merge policy can indicate that buckets are to be merged more or less frequently, etc. In some cases, the bucket merge policy can indicate that due to increased processing demands by other indexing nodes 404 or other components of an indexing node 404, such as processing and storing buckets, that bucket merges are to occur less frequently so that the computing resources used to merge buckets can be redirected to other tasks. It will be understood that a variety of priorities and policies can be used as part of the bucket merge policy.
At block 1210, the indexing node 404 stores the merged buckets in common storage 216. In certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 can store the merged buckets based on the bucket merge policy. For example, based on the bucket merge policy indicating that merged buckets are to satisfy a size threshold, the indexing node 404 can store a merged bucket once it satisfies the size threshold. Similarly, the indexing node 404 can store the merged buckets after a predetermined amount of time or during non-working hours, etc., per the bucket merge policy.
In response to the storage of the merged buckets in common storage 216, the indexing node 404 can receive an acknowledgement that the merged buckets have been stored. In some cases, the acknowledgement can include information about the merged buckets, including, but not limited to, a storage location in common storage 216, identifier, etc.
At block 1212, the indexing node 404 updates the data store catalog 220. As described herein, the indexing node 404 can store information about the merged buckets in the data store catalog. 220. The information can be similar to the information stored in the data store catalog 220 for the pre-merged buckets (buckets used to create the merged buckets). For example, in some cases, the indexing node 404 can store any one or any combination of the following in the data store catalog: the tenant or partition associated with the merged buckets, a time range of the merged bucket, the location information of the merged bucket in common storage 216, metadata fields associated with the bucket (e.g., host, source, sourcetype), etc. As mentioned, the information about the merged buckets in the data store catalog 220 can be used by the query system 214 to identify relevant buckets for a search. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the data store catalog 220 can be used in a similar fashion as an inverted index, and can include similar information (e.g., time ranges, field-value pairs, keyword pairs, location information, etc.). However, instead of providing information about individual events in a bucket, the data store catalog 220 can provide information about individual buckets in common storage 216.
In some cases, the indexing node 404 can retrieve information from the data store catalog 220 about the pre-merged buckets and use that information to generate information about the merged bucket(s) for storage in the data store catalog 220. For example, the indexing node 404 can use the time ranges of the pre-merged buckets to generate a merged time range, identify metadata fields associated with the different events in the pre-merged buckets, etc. In certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 can generate the information about the merged buckets for the data store catalog 220 from the merged data itself without retrieving information about the pre-merged buckets from the data store catalog 220.
In certain embodiments, as part of updating the data store catalog 220 with information about the merged buckets, the indexing node 404 can delete the information in the data store catalog 220 about the pre-merged buckets. For example, once the merged bucket is stored in common storage 216, the merged bucket can be used for queries. As such, the information about the pre-merged buckets can be removed so that the query system 214 does not use the pre-merged buckets to execute a query.
Fewer, more, or different blocks can be used as part of the routine 1200. In some cases, one or more blocks can be omitted. For example, in certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 can delete locally stored buckets. In some cases, the indexing node 404 deletes any buckets used to form merged buckets and/or the merged buckets. In this way, the indexing node 404 can reduce the amount of data stored in the indexing node 404.
In certain embodiments, the indexing node 404 can instruct the common storage 216 to delete buckets or delete the buckets in common storage according to a bucket management policy. For example, the indexing node 404 can instruct the common storage 216 to delete any buckets used to generate the merged buckets. Based on the bucket management policy, the common storage 216 can remove the buckets. As described herein, the bucket management policy can indicate when buckets are to be removed from common storage 216. For example, the bucket management policy can indicate that buckets are to be removed from common storage 216 after a predetermined amount of time, once any queries relying on the pre-merged buckets are completed, etc.
By removing buckets from common storage 216, the indexing node 404 can reduce the size or amount of data stored in common storage 216 and improve search times. For example, in some cases, large buckets can increase search times as there are fewer buckets for the query system 214 to search. By another example, merging buckets after indexing allows optimal or near-optimal bucket sizes for search (e.g., performed by query system 214) and index (e.g., performed by indexing system 212) to be determined independently or near-independently.
Furthermore, it will be understood that the various blocks described herein with reference to
4.3. Querying
Further, it will be understood that the various functions described herein with respect to
At (1) and (2), the indexing system 212 monitors the storage of processed data and updates the data store catalog 220 based on the monitoring. As described herein, one or more components of the indexing system 212, such as the partition manager 408 and/or the indexer 410 can monitor the storage of data or buckets to common storage 216. As the data is stored in common storage 216, the indexing system 212 can obtain information about the data stored in the common storage 216, such as, but not limited to, location information, bucket identifiers, tenant identifier (e.g., for buckets that are single tenant) etc. The indexing system 212 can use the received information about the data stored in common storage 216 to update the data store catalog 220.
Furthermore, as described herein, in some embodiments, the indexing system 212 can merge buckets into one or more merged buckets, store the merged buckets in common storage 216, and update the data store catalog to 220 with the information about the merged buckets stored in common storage 216.
At (3) and (4), the search node monitor 508 monitors the search nodes 506 and updates the search node catalog 510. As described herein, the search node monitor 508 can monitor the availability, responsiveness, and/or utilization rate of the search nodes 506. Based on the status of the search nodes 506, the search node monitor 508 can update the search node catalog 510. In this way, the search node catalog 510 can retain information regarding a current status of each of the search nodes 506 in the query system 214.
At (5), the search head 504 receives a query and generates a search manager 514. As described herein, in some cases, a search master 512 can generate the search manager 514. For example, the search master 512 can spin up or instantiate a new process, container, or virtual machine, or copy itself to generate the search manager 514, etc. As described herein, in some embodiments, the search manager 514 can perform one or more of functions described herein with reference to
The search head 504 (6A) requests data identifiers from the data store catalog 220 and (6B) requests an identification of available search nodes from the search node catalog 510. As described, the data store catalog 220 can include information regarding the data stored in common storage 216 and the search node catalog 510 can include information regarding the search nodes 506 of the query system 214. Accordingly, the search head 504 can query the respective catalogs to identify data or buckets that include data that satisfies at least a portion of the query and search nodes available to execute the query. In some cases, these requests can be done concurrently or in any order.
At (7A), the data store catalog 220 provides the search head 504 with an identification of data that satisfies at least a portion of the query. As described herein, in response to the request from the search head 504, the data store catalog 220 can be used to identify and return identifiers of buckets in common storage 216 and/or location information of data in common storage 216 that satisfy at least a portion of the query or at least some filter criteria (e.g., buckets associated with an identified tenant or partition or that satisfy an identified time range, etc.).
In some cases, as the data store catalog 220 can routinely receive updates by the indexing system 212, it can implement a read-write lock while it is being queried by the search head 504. Furthermore, the data store catalog 220 can store information regarding which buckets were identified for the search. In this way, the data store catalog 220 can be used by the indexing system 212 to determine which buckets in common storage 216 can be removed or deleted as part of a merge operation.
At (7B), the search node catalog 510 provides the search head 504 with an identification of available search nodes 506. As described herein, in response to the request from the search head 504, the search node catalog 510 can be used to identify and return identifiers for search nodes 506 that are available to execute the query.
At (8) the search head 504 maps the identified search nodes 506 to the data according to a search node mapping policy. In some cases, per the search node mapping policy, the search head 504 can dynamically map search nodes 506 to the identified data or buckets. As described herein, the search head 504 can map the identified search nodes 506 to the identified data or buckets at one time or iteratively as the buckets are searched according to the search node mapping policy. In certain embodiments, per the search node mapping policy, the search head 504 can map the identified search nodes 506 to the identified data based on previous assignments, data stored in a local or shared data store of one or more search heads 506, network architecture of the search nodes 506, a hashing algorithm, etc.
In some cases, as some of the data may reside in a local or shared data store between the search nodes 506, the search head 504 can attempt to map that was previously assigned to a search node 506 to the same search node 506. In certain embodiments, to map the data to the search nodes 506, the search head 504 uses the identifiers, such as bucket identifiers, received from the data store catalog 220. In some embodiments, the search head 504 performs a hash function to map a bucket identifier to a search node 506. In some cases, the search head 504 uses a consistent hash algorithm to increase the probability of mapping a bucket identifier to the same search node 506.
In certain embodiments, the search head 504 or query system 214 can maintain a table or list of bucket mappings to search nodes 506. In such embodiments, per the search node mapping policy, the search head 504 can use the mapping to identify previous assignments between search nodes and buckets. If a particular bucket identifier has not been assigned to a search node 506, the search head 504 can use a hash algorithm to assign it to a search node 506. In certain embodiments, prior to using the mapping for a particular bucket, the search head 504 can confirm that the search node 506 that was previously assigned to the particular bucket is available for the query. In some embodiments, if the search node 506 is not available for the query, the search head 504 can determine whether another search node 506 that shares a data store with the unavailable search node 506 is available for the query. If the search head 504 determines that an available search node 506 shares a data store with the unavailable search node 506, the search head 504 can assign the identified available search node 506 to the bucket identifier that was previously assigned to the now unavailable search node 506.
At (9), the search head 504 instructs the search nodes 506 to execute the query. As described herein, based on the assignment of buckets to the search nodes 506, the search head 504 can generate search instructions for each of the assigned search nodes 506. These instructions can be in various forms, including, but not limited to, JSON, DAG, etc. In some cases, the search head 504 can generate sub-queries for the search nodes 506. Each sub-query or instructions for a particular search node 506 generated for the search nodes 506 can identify the buckets that are to be searched, the filter criteria to identify a subset of the set of data to be processed, and the manner of processing the subset of data. Accordingly, the instructions can provide the search nodes 506 with the relevant information to execute their particular portion of the query.
At (10), the search nodes 506 obtain the data to be searched. As described herein, in some cases the data to be searched can be stored on one or more local or shared data stores of the search nodes 506. In certain embodiments, the data to be searched is located in the common storage 216. In such embodiments, the search nodes 506 or a cache manager 516 can obtain the data from the common storage 216.
In some cases, the cache manager 516 can identify or obtain the data requested by the search nodes 506. For example, if the requested data is stored on the local or shared data store of the search nodes 506, the cache manager 516 can identify the location of the data for the search nodes 506. If the requested data is stored in common storage 216, the cache manager 516 can obtain the data from the common storage 216.
As described herein, in some embodiments, the cache manager 516 can obtain a subset of the files associated with the bucket to be searched by the search nodes 506. For example, based on the query, the search node 506 can determine that a subset of the files of a bucket are to be used to execute the query. Accordingly, the search node 506 can request the subset of files, as opposed to all files of the bucket. The cache manager 516 can download the subset of files from common storage 216 and provide them to the search node 506 for searching.
In some embodiments, such as when a search node 506 cannot uniquely identify the file of a bucket to be searched, the cache manager 516 can download a bucket summary or manifest that identifies the files associated with the bucket. The search node 506 can use the bucket summary or manifest to uniquely identify the file to be used in the query. The common storage 216 can then obtain that uniquely identified file from common storage 216.
At (11), the search nodes 506 search and process the data. As described herein, the sub-queries or instructions received from the search head 504 can instruct the search nodes 506 to identify data within one or more buckets and perform one or more transformations on the data. Accordingly, each search node 506 can identify a subset of the set of data to be processed and process the subset of data according to the received instructions. This can include searching the contents of one or more inverted indexes of a bucket or the raw machine data or events of a bucket, etc. In some embodiments, based on the query or sub-query, a search node 506 can perform one or more transformations on the data received from each bucket or on aggregate data from the different buckets that are searched by the search node 506.
At (12), the search head 504 monitors the status of the query of the search nodes 506. As described herein, the search nodes 506 can become unresponsive or fail for a variety of reasons (e.g., network failure, error, high utilization rate, etc.). Accordingly, during execution of the query, the search head 504 can monitor the responsiveness and availability of the search nodes 506. In some cases, this can be done by pinging or querying the search nodes 506, establishing a persistent communication link with the search nodes 506, or receiving status updates from the search nodes 506. In some cases, the status can indicate the buckets that have been searched by the search nodes 506, the number or percentage of remaining buckets to be searched, the percentage of the query that has been executed by the search node 506, etc. In some cases, based on a determination that a search node 506 has become unresponsive, the search head 504 can assign a different search node 506 to complete the portion of the query assigned to the unresponsive search node 506.
In certain embodiments, depending on the status of the search nodes 506, the search manager 514 can dynamically assign or re-assign buckets to search nodes 506. For example, as search nodes 506 complete their search of buckets assigned to them, the search manager 514 can assign additional buckets for search. As yet another example, if one search node 506 is 95% complete with its search while another search node 506 is less than 50% complete, the query manager can dynamically assign additional buckets to the search node 506 that is 95% complete or re-assign buckets from the search node 506 that is less than 50% complete to the search node that is 95% complete. In this way, the search manager 514 can improve the efficiency of how a computing system performs searches through the search manager 514 increasing parallelization of searching and decreasing the search time.
At (13), the search nodes 506 send individual query results to the search head 504. As described herein, the search nodes 506 can send the query results as they are obtained from the buckets and/or send the results once they are completed by a search node 506. In some embodiments, as the search head 504 receives results from individual search nodes 506, it can track the progress of the query. For example, the search head 504 can track which buckets have been searched by the search nodes 506. Accordingly, in the event a search node 506 becomes unresponsive or fails, the search head 504 can assign a different search node 506 to complete the portion of the query assigned to the unresponsive search node 506. By tracking the buckets that have been searched by the search nodes and instructing different search node 506 to continue searching where the unresponsive search node 506 left off, the search head 504 can reduce the delay caused by a search node 506 becoming unresponsive, and can aid in providing a stateless searching service.
At (14), the search head 504 processes the results from the search nodes 506. As described herein, the search head 504 can perform one or more transformations on the data received from the search nodes 506. For example, some queries can include transformations that cannot be completed until the data is aggregated from the different search nodes 506. In some embodiments, the search head 504 can perform these transformations.
At (15), the search head 504 stores results in the query acceleration data store 222. As described herein, in some cases some, all, or a copy of the results of the query can be stored in the query acceleration data store 222. The results stored in the query acceleration data store 222 can be combined with other results already stored in the query acceleration data store 222 and/or be combined with subsequent results. For example, in some cases, the query system 214 can receive ongoing queries, or queries that do not have a predetermined end time. In such cases, as the search head 504 receives a first set of results, it can store the first set of results in the query acceleration data store 222. As subsequent results are received, the search head 504 can add them to the first set of results, and so forth. In this way, rather than executing the same or similar query data across increasingly larger time ranges, the query system 214 can execute the query across a first time range and then aggregate the results of the query with the results of the query across the second time range. In this way, the query system can reduce the amount of queries and the size of queries being executed and can provide query results in a more time efficient manner.
At (16), the search head 504 terminates the search manager 514. As described herein, in some embodiments a search head 504 or a search master 512 can generate a search manager 514 for each query assigned to the search head 504. Accordingly, in some embodiments, upon completion of a search, the search head 504 or search master 512 can terminate the search manager 514. In certain embodiments, rather than terminating the search manager 514 upon completion of a query, the search head 504 can assign the search manager 514 to a new query.
As mentioned previously, in some of embodiments, one or more of the functions described herein with respect to
4.3.1. Containerized Search Nodes
At block 1402, the search manager 514 receives a query. As described in greater detail above, the search manager 514 can receive the query from the search head 504, search master 512, etc. In some cases, the search manager 514 can receive the query from a client device 204. The query can be in a query language as described in greater detail above. In some cases, the query received by the search manager 514 can correspond to a query received and reviewed by the search head 504. For example, the search head 504 can determine whether the query was submitted by an authenticated user and/or review the query to determine that it is in a proper format for the data intake and query system 108, has correct semantics and syntax, etc. In some cases, the search head 504 can use a search master 512 to receive search queries, and in some cases, spawn the search manager 514 to process and execute the query.
At block 1404, the search manager 514 identifies one or more containerized search nodes, e.g., search nodes 506, to execute the query. As described herein, the query system 214 can include multiple containerized search nodes 506 to execute queries. One or more of the containerized search nodes 506 can be instantiated on the same computing device, and share the resources of the computing device. In addition, the containerized search nodes 506 can enable the query system 214 to provide a highly extensible and dynamic searching service. For example, based on resource availability and/or workload, the query system 214 can instantiate additional containerized search nodes 506 or terminate containerized search nodes 506. Furthermore, the query system 214 can dynamically assign containerized search nodes 506 to execute queries on data in common storage 216 based on a search node mapping policy.
As described herein, each search node 506 can be implemented using containerization or operating-system-level virtualization, or other virtualization technique. For example, the containerized search node 506, or one or more components of the search node 506 can be implemented as separate containers or container instances. Each container instance can have certain resources (e.g., memory, processor, etc.) of the underlying computing system assigned to it, but may share the same operating system and may use the operating system's system call interface. Further, each container may run the same or different computer applications concurrently or separately, and may interact with each other. It will be understood that other virtualization techniques can be used. For example, the containerized search nodes 506 can be implemented using virtual machines using full virtualization or paravirtualization, etc.
In some embodiments, the search node 506 can be implemented as a group of related containers or a pod, and the various components of the search node 506 can be implemented as related containers of a pod. Further, the search node 506 can assign different containers to execute different tasks. For example one container of a containerized search node 506 can receive and query instructions, a second container can obtain the data or buckets to be searched, and a third container of the containerized search node 506 can search the buckets and/or perform one or more transformations on the data. However, it will be understood that the containerized search node 506 can be implemented in a variety of configurations. For example, in some cases, the containerized search node 506 can be implemented as a single container and can include multiple processes to implement the tasks described above by the three containers. Any combination of containerization and processed can be used to implement the containerized search node 506 as desired.
In some cases, the search manager 514 can identify the search nodes 506 using the search node catalog 510. For example, as described herein a search node monitor 508 can monitor the status of the search nodes 506 instantiated in the query system 514 and monitor their status. The search node monitor can store the status of the search nodes 506 in the search node catalog 510.
In certain embodiments, the search manager 514 can identify search nodes 506 using a search node mapping policy, previous mappings, previous searches, or the contents of a data store associated with the search nodes 506. For example, based on the previous assignment of a search node 506 to search data as part of a query, the search manager 514 can assign the search node 506 to search the same data for a different query. As another example, as search nodes 506 search data, it can cache the data in a local or shared data store. Based on the data in the cache, the search manager 514 can assign the search node 506 to search the again as part of a different query.
In certain embodiments, the search manager 514 can identify search nodes 506 based on shared resources. For example, if the search manager 514 determines that a search node 506 shares a data store with a search node 506 that previously performed a search on data and cached the data in the shared data store, the search manager 514 can assign the search node 506 that share the data store to search the data stored therein as part of a different query.
In some embodiments, the search manager 514 can identify search nodes 506 using a hashing algorithm. For example, as described herein, the search manager 514 based can perform a hash on a bucket identifier of a bucket that is to be searched to identify a search node to search the bucket. In some implementations, that hash may be a consistent hash, to increase the chance that the same search node will be selected to search that bucket as was previously used, thereby reducing the chance that the bucket must be retrieved from common storage 216.
It will be understood that the search manger 514 can identify search nodes 506 based on any one or any combination of the aforementioned methods. Furthermore, it will be understood that the search manager 514 can identify search nodes 506 in a variety of ways.
At 1406, the search manager 514 instructs the search nodes 506 to execute the query. As described herein, the search manager 514 can process the query to determine portions of the query that it will execute and portions of the query to be executed by the search nodes 506. Furthermore, the search manager 514 can generate instructions or sub-queries for each search node 506 that is to execute a portion of the query. In some cases, the search manager 514 generates a DAG for execution by the search nodes 506. The instructions or sub-queries can identify the data or buckets to be searched by the search nodes 506. In addition, the instructions or sub-queries may identify one or more transformations that the search nodes 506 are to perform on the data.
Fewer, more, or different blocks can be used as part of the routine 1400. In some cases, one or more blocks can be omitted. For example, in certain embodiments, the search manager 514 can receive partial results from the search nodes 506, process the partial results, perform one or more transformation on the partial results or aggregated results, etc. Further, in some embodiments, the search manager 514 provide the results to a client device 204. In some embodiments, the search manager 514 can combine the results with results stored in the accelerated data store 222 or store the results in the accelerated data store 222 for combination with additional search results.
In some cases, the search manager 514 can identify the data or buckets to be searched by, for example, using the data store catalog 220, and map the buckets to the search nodes 506 according to a search node mapping policy. As described herein, the data store catalog 220 can receive updates from the indexing system 212 about the data that is stored in common storage 216. The information in the data store catalog 220 can include, but is not limited to, information about the location of the buckets in common storage 216, and other information that can be used by the search manager 514 to identify buckets that include data that satisfies at least a portion of the query.
In certain cases, as part of executing the query, the search nodes 506 can obtain the data to be searched from common storage 216 using the cache manager 516. The obtained data can be stored on a local or shared data store and searched as part of the query. In addition, the data can be retained on the local or shared data store based on a bucket caching policy as described herein.
Furthermore, it will be understood that the various blocks described herein with reference to
4.3.2. Identifying Buckets and Search Nodes for Query
At block 1502, the search manager 514 receives a query, as described in greater detail herein at least with reference to block 1402 of
At block 1504, the search manager 514 identifies search nodes to execute the query, as described in greater detail herein at least with reference to block 1404 of
At block 1506, the search manager 514 identifies buckets to query. As described herein, in some cases, the search manager 514 can consult the data store catalog 220 to identify buckets to be searched. In certain embodiments, the search manager 514 can use metadata of the buckets stored in common storage 216 to identify the buckets for the query. For example, the search manager 514 can compare a tenant identifier and/or partition identifier associated with the query with the tenant identifier and/or partition identifier of the buckets. The search manager 514 can exclude buckets that have a tenant identifier and/or partition identifier that does not match the tenant identifier and/or partition identifier associated with the query. Similarly, the search manager can compare a time range associate with the query with the time range associated with the buckets in common storage 216. Based on the comparison, the search manager 514 can identify buckets that satisfy the time range associated with the query (e.g., at least partly overlap with the time range from the query).
At 1508, the search manager 514 executes the query. As described herein, at least with reference to 1406 of
Fewer, more, or different blocks can be used as part of the routine 1500. In some cases, one or more blocks can be omitted. For example, as described herein, the search manager 514 can map the search nodes 506 to certain data or buckets for the search according to a search node mapping policy. Based on the search node mapping policy, search manager 514 can instruct the search nodes to search the buckets to which they are mapped. Further, as described herein, in some cases, the search node mapping policy can indicate that the search manager 514 is to use a hashing algorithm, previous assignment, network architecture, cache information, etc., to map the search nodes 506 to the buckets.
As another example, the routine 1500 can include storing the search results in the accelerated data store 222. Furthermore, as described herein, the search nodes 506 can store buckets from common storage 216 to a local or shared data store for searching, etc.
In addition, it will be understood that the various blocks described herein with reference to
4.3.3. Identifying Buckets for Query Execution
At block 1602, the data intake and query system 108 maintains a catalog of bucket in common storage 216. As described herein, the catalog can also be referred to as the data store catalog 220, and can include information about the buckets in common storage 216, such as, but not limited to, location information, metadata fields, tenant and partition information, time range information, etc. Further, the data store catalog 220 can be kept up-to-date based on information received from the indexing system 212 as the indexing system 212 processes and stores data in the common storage 216.
At block 1604, the search manager 514 receives a query, as described in greater detail herein at least with reference to block 1402 of
At block 1606, the search manager 514 identifies buckets to be searched as part of the query using the data store catalog 220. As described herein, the search manager 514 can use the data store catalog 220 to filter the universe of buckets in the common storage 216 to buckets that include data that satisfies at least a portion of the query. For example, if a query includes a time range of 4/23/18 from 03:30:50 to 04:53:32, the search manager 514 can use the time range information in the data store catalog to identify buckets with a time range that overlaps with the time range provided in the query. In addition, if the query indicates that only a _main partition is to be searched, the search manager 514 can use the information in the data store catalog to identify buckets that satisfy the time range and are associated with the _main partition. Accordingly, depending on the information in the query and the information stored in the data store catalog 220 about the buckets, the search manager 514 can reduce the number of buckets to be searched. In this way, the data store catalog 220 can reduce search time and the processing resources used to execute a query.
At block 1608, the search manager 514 executes the query, as described in greater detail herein at least with reference to block 1508 of
Fewer, more, or different blocks can be used as part of the routine 1600. In some cases, one or more blocks can be omitted. For example, as described herein, the search manager 514 can identify and map search nodes 506 to the buckets for searching or store the search results in the accelerated data store 222. Furthermore, as described herein, the search nodes 506 can store buckets from common storage 216 to a local or shared data store for searching, etc. In addition, it will be understood that the various blocks described herein with reference to
4.3.4. Identifying Search Nodes for Query Execution
At block 1702, the query system 214 maintains a catalog of instantiated search nodes 506. As described herein, the catalog can also be referred to as the search node catalog 510, and can include information about the search nodes 506, such as, but not limited to, availability, utilization, responsiveness, network architecture, etc. Further, the search node catalog 510 can be kept up-to-date based on information received by the search node monitor 508 from the search nodes 506.
At block 1704, the search manager 514 receives a query, as described in greater detail herein at least with reference to block 1402 of
At block 1708, the search manager 514 instructs the search nodes 506 to execute the query, as described in greater detail herein at least with reference to block 1406 of
Fewer, more, or different blocks can be used as part of the routine 1700. In some cases, one or more blocks can be omitted. For example, in certain embodiments, the search manager can identify buckets in common storage 216 for searching. In addition, it will be understood that the various blocks described herein with reference to
4.3.5. Hashing Bucket Identifiers for Query Execution
At block 1802, the search manager 514 receives a query, as described in greater detail herein at least with reference to block 1402 of
At block 1804, the search manager 514 identifies bucket identifiers associated with buckets to be searched as part of the query. The bucket identifiers can correspond to an alphanumeric identifier or other identifier that can be used to uniquely identify the bucket from other buckets stored in common storage 216. In some embodiments, the unique identifier may incorporate one or more portions of a tenant identifier, partition identifier, or time range of the bucket or a random or sequential (e.g., based on time of storage, creation, etc.) alphanumeric string, etc. As described herein, the search manager 514 can parse the query to identify buckets to be searched. In some cases, the search manager 514 can identify buckets to be searched and an associated bucket identifier based on metadata of the buckets and/or using a data store catalog 220. However, it will be understood that the search manager 514 can use a variety of techniques to identify buckets to be searched.
At block 1806, the search manager 514 performs a hash function on the bucket identifiers. The search manager can, in some embodiments, use the output of the hash function to identify a search node 506 to search the bucket. For example, as a non-limiting example, consider a scenario in which a bucket identifier is 4149 and the search manager 514 identified ten search nodes to process the query. The search manager 514 could perform a modulo ten operation on the bucket identifier to determine which search node 506 is to search the bucket. Based on this example, the search manager 514 would assign the ninth search node 506 to search the bucket, e.g., because the value 4149 modulo ten is 9, so the bucket having the identifier 4149 is assigned to the ninth search node. In some cases, the search manager can use a consistent hash to increase the likelihood that the same search node 506 is repeatedly assigned to the same bucket for searching. In this way, the search manager 514 can increase the likelihood that the bucket to be searched is already located in a local or shared data store of the search node 506, and reduce the likelihood that the bucket will be downloaded from common storage 216. It will be understood that the search manager can use a variety of techniques to map the bucket to a search node 506 according to a search node mapping policy. For example, the search manager 514 can use previous assignments, network architecture, etc., to assign buckets to search nodes 506 according to the search node mapping policy.
At block 1808, the search manager 514 instructs the search nodes 506 to execute the query, as described in greater detail herein at least with reference to block 1508 of
Fewer, more, or different blocks can be used as part of the routine 1800. In some cases, one or more blocks can be omitted. In addition, it will be understood that the various blocks described herein with reference to
4.3.6. Obtaining Data for Query Execution
Further, although described as being implemented by the search node 506, it will be understood that the elements outlined for routine 1900 can be implemented by one or more computing devices/components that are associated with the data intake and query system 108, such as, but not limited to, the query system manager 502, the search head 504, the search master 512, search manager 514, cache manager 516, etc. Thus, the following illustrative embodiment should not be construed as limiting.
At block 1902, the search node 506 receives instructions for a query or sub-query. As described herein, a search manager 514 can receive and parse a query to determine the tasks to be assigned to the search nodes 506, such as, but not limited to, the searching of one or more buckets in common storage 216, etc. The search node 506 can parse the instructions and identify the buckets that are to be searched. In some cases, the search node 506 can determine that a bucket that is to be searched is not located in the search nodes local or shared data store.
At block 1904, the search node 506 obtains the bucket from common storage 216. As described herein, in some embodiments, the search node 506 obtains the bucket from common storage 216 in conjunction with a cache manager 516. For example, the search node 506 can request the cache manager 516 to identify the location of the bucket. The cache manager 516 can review the data stored in the local or shared data store for the bucket. If the cache manager 516 cannot locate the bucket in the local or shared data store, it can inform the search node 506 that the bucket is not stored locally and that it will be retrieved from common storage 216. As described herein, in some cases, the cache manager 516 can download a portion of the bucket (e.g., one or more files) and provide the portion of the bucket to the search node 506 as part of informing the search node 506 that the bucket is not found locally. The search node 506 can use the downloaded portion of the bucket to identify any other portions of the bucket that are to be retrieved from common storage 216.
Accordingly, as described herein, the search node 506 can retrieve all or portions of the bucket from common storage 216 and store the retrieved portions to a local or shared data store.
At block 1906, the search node 506 executes the search on the portions of the bucket stored in the local data store. As described herein, the search node 506 can review one or more files of the bucket to identify data that satisfies the query. In some cases, the search nodes 506 searches an inverted index to identify the data. In certain embodiments, the search node 506 searches the raw machine data, uses one or more configuration files, regex rules, and/or late binding schema to identify data in the bucket that satisfies the query.
Fewer, more, or different blocks can be used as part of the routine 1900. For example, in certain embodiments, the routine 1900 includes blocks for requesting a cache manager 516 to search for the bucket in the local or shared storage, and a block for informing the search node 506 that the requested bucket is not available in the local or shared data store. As another example, the routine 1900 can include performing one or more transformations on the data, and providing partial search results to a search manager 514, etc. In addition, it will be understood that the various blocks described herein with reference to
4.3.7. Caching Search Results
At block 2002, the search manager 514 receives a query, and at block 2004, the search manager 514 executes the query, as described in greater detail herein at least with reference to block 1508 of
At block 2006, the search manager 514 stores the results in the accelerated data store 222. As described herein, the results can be combined with results previously stored in the accelerated data store 222 and/or can be stored for combination with results to be obtained later in time. In some cases, the search manager 514 can receive queries and determine that at least a portion of the results are stored in the accelerated data store 222. Based on the identification, the search manager 514 can generate instructions for the search nodes 506 to obtain results to the query that are not stored in the accelerated data store 222, combine the results in the accelerated data store 222 with results obtained by the search nodes 506, and provide the aggregated search results to the client device 204, or store the aggregated search results in the accelerated data store 222 for further aggregation. By storing results in the accelerated data store 222, the search manager 514 can reduce the search time and computing resources used for future searches that rely on the query results.
Fewer, more, or different blocks can be used as part of the routine 2000. In some cases, one or more blocks can be omitted. For example, in certain embodiments, the search manager 514 can consult a data store catalog 220 to identify buckets, consult a search node catalog 510 to identify available search nodes, map buckets to search nodes 506, etc. Further, in some cases, the search nodes 506 can retrieve buckets from common storage 216. In addition, it will be understood that the various blocks described herein with reference to
4.4. Data Ingestion, Indexing, and Storage Flow
4.4.1. Input
At block 2102, the intake system 210 receives data from an input source, such as a data source 202 shown in
At block 504, the intake system 210 publishes the data as messages on an output ingestion buffer 310. Illustratively, other components of the data intake and query system 108 may be configured to subscribe to various topics on the output ingestion buffer 310, thus receiving the data of the messages when published to the buffer 310.
4.4.2. Parsing
At block 2106, the indexing system 212 receives messages from the intake system 210 (e.g., by obtaining the messages from the output ingestion buffer 310) and parses the data of the message to organize the data into events. In some embodiments, to organize the data into events, the indexing system 212 may determine a source type associated with each message (e.g., by extracting a source type label from the metadata fields associated with the message, etc.) and refer to a source type configuration corresponding to the identified source type. The source type definition may include one or more properties that indicate to the indexing system 212 to automatically determine the boundaries within the received data that indicate the portions of machine data for events. In general, these properties may include regular expression-based rules or delimiter rules where, for example, event boundaries may be indicated by predefined characters or character strings. These predefined characters may include punctuation marks or other special characters including, for example, carriage returns, tabs, spaces, line breaks, etc. If a source type for the data is unknown to the indexing system 212, the indexing system 212 may infer a source type for the data by examining the structure of the data. Then, the indexing system 212 can apply an inferred source type definition to the data to create the events.
At block 2108, the indexing system 212 determines a timestamp for each event. Similar to the process for parsing machine data, an indexing system 212 may again refer to a source type definition associated with the data to locate one or more properties that indicate instructions for determining a timestamp for each event. The properties may, for example, instruct the indexing system 212 to extract a time value from a portion of data for the event, to interpolate time values based on timestamps associated with temporally proximate events, to create a timestamp based on a time the portion of machine data was received or generated, to use the timestamp of a previous event, or use any other rules for determining timestamps.
At block 2110, the indexing system 212 associates with each event one or more metadata fields including a field containing the timestamp determined for the event. In some embodiments, a timestamp may be included in the metadata fields. These metadata fields may include any number of “default fields” that are associated with all events, and may also include one more custom fields as defined by a user. Similar to the metadata fields associated with the data blocks at block 2104, the default metadata fields associated with each event may include a host, source, and source type field including or in addition to a field storing the timestamp.
At block 2112, the indexing system 212 may optionally apply one or more transformations to data included in the events created at block 2106. For example, such transformations can include removing a portion of an event (e.g., a portion used to define event boundaries, extraneous characters from the event, other extraneous text, etc.), masking a portion of an event (e.g., masking a credit card number), removing redundant portions of an event, etc. The transformations applied to events may, for example, be specified in one or more configuration files and referenced by one or more source type definitions.
As mentioned above, certain metadata, e.g., host 2136, source 2137, source type 2138 and timestamps 2135 can be generated for each event, and associated with a corresponding portion of machine data 2139 when storing the event data in a data store, e.g., data store 212. Any of the metadata can be extracted from the corresponding machine data, or supplied or defined by an entity, such as a user or computer system. The metadata fields can become part of or stored with the event. Note that while the time-stamp metadata field can be extracted from the raw data of each event, the values for the other metadata fields may be determined by the indexing system 212 or indexing node 404 based on information it receives pertaining to the source of the data separate from the machine data.
While certain default or user-defined metadata fields can be extracted from the machine data for indexing purposes, all the machine data within an event can be maintained in its original condition. As such, in embodiments in which the portion of machine data included in an event is unprocessed or otherwise unaltered, it is referred to herein as a portion of raw machine data. In other embodiments, the port of machine data in an event can be processed or otherwise altered. As such, unless certain information needs to be removed for some reasons (e.g. extraneous information, confidential information), all the raw machine data contained in an event can be preserved and saved in its original form. Accordingly, the data store in which the event records are stored is sometimes referred to as a “raw record data store.” The raw record data store contains a record of the raw event data tagged with the various default fields.
In
In the example shown in
Event 2134 is associated with an entry in a server error log, as indicated by “error.log” in the source column 2137 that records errors that the server encountered when processing a client request. Similar to the events related to the server access log, all the raw machine data in the error log file pertaining to event 2134 can be preserved and stored as part of the event 2134.
Saving minimally processed or unprocessed machine data in a data store associated with metadata fields in the manner similar to that shown in
4.4.3. Indexing
At blocks 2114 and 2116, the indexing system 212 can optionally generate a keyword index to facilitate fast keyword searching for events. To build a keyword index, at block 2114, the indexing system 212 identifies a set of keywords in each event. At block 2116, the indexing system 212 includes the identified keywords in an index, which associates each stored keyword with reference pointers to events containing that keyword (or to locations within events where that keyword is located, other location identifiers, etc.). When the data intake and query system 108 subsequently receives a keyword-based query, the query system 214 can access the keyword index to quickly identify events containing the keyword.
In some embodiments, the keyword index may include entries for field name-value pairs found in events, where a field name-value pair can include a pair of keywords connected by a symbol, such as an equals sign or colon. This way, events containing these field name-value pairs can be quickly located. In some embodiments, fields can automatically be generated for some or all of the field names of the field name-value pairs at the time of indexing. For example, if the string “dest=10.0.1.2” is found in an event, a field named “dest” may be created for the event, and assigned a value of “10.0.1.2”.
At block 2118, the indexing system 212 stores the events with an associated timestamp in a local data store 212 and/or common storage 216. Timestamps enable a user to search for events based on a time range. In some embodiments, the stored events are organized into “buckets,” where each bucket stores events associated with a specific time range based on the timestamps associated with each event. This improves time-based searching, as well as allows for events with recent timestamps, which may have a higher likelihood of being accessed, to be stored in a faster memory to facilitate faster retrieval. For example, buckets containing the most recent events can be stored in flash memory rather than on a hard disk. In some embodiments, each bucket may be associated with an identifier, a time range, and a size constraint.
The indexing system 212 may be responsible for storing the events contained in various data stores 218 of common storage 216. By distributing events among the data stores in common storage 216, the query system 214 can analyze events for a query in parallel. For example, using map-reduce techniques, each search node 506 can return partial responses for a subset of events to a search head that combines the results to produce an answer for the query. By storing events in buckets for specific time ranges, the indexing system 212 may further optimize the data retrieval process by enabling search nodes 506 to search buckets corresponding to time ranges that are relevant to a query.
In some embodiments, each indexing node 404 (e.g., the indexer 410 or data store 412) of the indexing system 212 has a home directory and a cold directory. The home directory stores hot buckets and warm buckets, and the cold directory stores cold buckets. A hot bucket is a bucket that is capable of receiving and storing events. A warm bucket is a bucket that can no longer receive events for storage but has not yet been moved to the cold directory. A cold bucket is a bucket that can no longer receive events and may be a bucket that was previously stored in the home directory. The home directory may be stored in faster memory, such as flash memory, as events may be actively written to the home directory, and the home directory may typically store events that are more frequently searched and thus are accessed more frequently. The cold directory may be stored in slower and/or larger memory, such as a hard disk, as events are no longer being written to the cold directory, and the cold directory may typically store events that are not as frequently searched and thus are accessed less frequently. In some embodiments, an indexing node 404 may also have a quarantine bucket that contains events having potentially inaccurate information, such as an incorrect time stamp associated with the event or a time stamp that appears to be an unreasonable time stamp for the corresponding event. The quarantine bucket may have events from any time range; as such, the quarantine bucket may always be searched at search time. Additionally, an indexing node 404 may store old, archived data in a frozen bucket that is not capable of being searched at search time. In some embodiments, a frozen bucket may be stored in slower and/or larger memory, such as a hard disk, and may be stored in offline and/or remote storage.
In some embodiments, an indexing node 404 may not include a cold directory and/or cold or frozen buckets. For example, as warm buckets and/or merged buckets are copied to common storage 216, they can be deleted from the indexing node 404. In certain embodiments, one or more data stores 218 of the common storage 216 can include a home directory that includes warm buckets copied from the indexing nodes 404 and a cold directory of cold or frozen buckets as described above.
Moreover, events and buckets can also be replicated across different indexing nodes 404 and data stores 218 of the common storage 216.
The data store 2101 can correspond to a data store 218 that stores events in common storage 216, a data store 412 associated with an indexing node 404, or a data store associated with a search peer 506. In the illustrated embodiment, the data store 2101 includes a _main directory 2103 associated with a _main partition and a _test directory 2105 associated with a _test partition. However, the data store 2101 can include fewer or more directories. In some embodiments, multiple indexes can share a single directory or all indexes can share a common directory. Additionally, although illustrated as a single data store 2101, it will be understood that the data store 2101 can be implemented as multiple data stores storing different portions of the information shown in
Furthermore, although not illustrated in
In the illustrated embodiment of
In some embodiments, the inverted index 2107A . . . 2107B, and 2109A . . . 2109B can correspond to a distinct time-series bucket stored in common storage 216, a search node 506, or an indexing node 404 and that contains events corresponding to the relevant partition (e.g., _main partition, _test partition). As such, each inverted index can correspond to a particular range of time for a partition. Additional files, such as high performance indexes for each time-series bucket of a partition, can also be stored in the same directory as the inverted indexes 2107A . . . 2107B, and 2109A . . . 2109B. In some embodiments inverted index 2107A . . . 2107B, and 2109A . . . 2109B can correspond to multiple time-series buckets or inverted indexes 2107A . . . 2107B, and 2109A . . . 2109B can correspond to a single time-series bucket.
Each inverted index 2107A . . . 2107B, and 2109A . . . 2109B can include one or more entries, such as keyword (or token) entries or field-value pair entries. Furthermore, in certain embodiments, the inverted indexes 2107A . . . 2107B, and 2109A . . . 2109B can include additional information, such as a time range 2123 associated with the inverted index or an partition identifier 2125 identifying the partition associated with the inverted index 2107A . . . 2107B, and 2109A . . . 2109B. However, each inverted index 2107A . . . 2107B, and 2109A . . . 2109B can include less or more information than depicted.
Token entries, such as token entries 2111 illustrated in inverted index 2107B, can include a token 2111A (e.g., “error,” “itemID,” etc.) and event references 2111B indicative of events that include the token. For example, for the token “error,” the corresponding token entry includes the token “error” and an event reference, or unique identifier, for each event stored in the corresponding time-series bucket that includes the token “error.” In the illustrated embodiment of
In some cases, some token entries can be default entries, automatically determined entries, or user specified entries. In some embodiments, the indexing system 212 can identify each word or string in an event as a distinct token and generate a token entry for the identified word or string. In some cases, the indexing system 212 can identify the beginning and ending of tokens based on punctuation, spaces, as described in greater detail herein. In certain cases, the indexing system 212 can rely on user input or a configuration file to identify tokens for token entries 2111, etc. It will be understood that any combination of token entries can be included as a default, automatically determined, or included based on user-specified criteria.
Similarly, field-value pair entries, such as field-value pair entries 2113 shown in inverted index 2107B, can include a field-value pair 2113A and event references 2113B indicative of events that include a field value that corresponds to the field-value pair. For example, for a field-value pair sourcetype::sendmail, a field-value pair entry can include the field-value pair sourcetype::sendmail and a unique identifier, or event reference, for each event stored in the corresponding time-series bucket that includes a sendmail sourcetype.
In some cases, the field-value pair entries 2113 can be default entries, automatically determined entries, or user specified entries. As a non-limiting example, the field-value pair entries for the fields host, source, sourcetype can be included in the inverted indexes 2107A . . . 2107B, and 2109A . . . 2109B as a default. As such, all of the inverted indexes 2107A . . . 2107B, and 2109A . . . 2109B can include field-value pair entries for the fields host, source, sourcetype. As yet another non-limiting example, the field-value pair entries for the IP_address field can be user specified and may only appear in the inverted index 2107B based on user-specified criteria. As another non-limiting example, as the indexing system 212 indexes the events, it can automatically identify field-value pairs and create field-value pair entries. For example, based on the indexing system's 212 review of events, it can identify IP_address as a field in each event and add the IP_address field-value pair entries to the inverted index 2107B. It will be understood that any combination of field-value pair entries can be included as a default, automatically determined, or included based on user-specified criteria.
Each unique identifier 2117, or event reference, can correspond to a unique event located in the time series bucket. However, the same event reference can be located in multiple entries. For example if an event has a sourcetype splunkd, host www1 and token “warning,” then the unique identifier for the event will appear in the field-value pair entries sourcetype::splunkd and host::www1, as well as the token entry “warning.” With reference to the illustrated embodiment of
For some fields, the unique identifier is located in only one field-value pair entry for a particular field. For example, the inverted index may include four sourcetype field-value pair entries corresponding to four different sourcetypes of the events stored in a bucket (e.g., sourcetypes: sendmail, splunkd, web_access, and web_service). Within those four sourcetype field-value pair entries, an identifier for a particular event may appear in only one of the field-value pair entries. With continued reference to the example illustrated embodiment of
The event references 2117 can be used to locate the events in the corresponding bucket. For example, the inverted index can include, or be associated with, an event reference array 2115. The event reference array 2115 can include an array entry 2117 for each event reference in the inverted index 2107B. Each array entry 2117 can include location information 2119 of the event corresponding to the unique identifier (non-limiting example: seek address of the event), a timestamp 2121 associated with the event, or additional information regarding the event associated with the event reference, etc.
For each token entry 2111 or field-value pair entry 2113, the event reference 2101B or unique identifiers can be listed in chronological order or the value of the event reference can be assigned based on chronological data, such as a timestamp associated with the event referenced by the event reference. For example, the event reference 1 in the illustrated embodiment of
As a non-limiting example of how the inverted indexes 2107A . . . 2107B, and 2109A . . . 2109B can be used during a data categorization request command, the query system 214 can receive filter criteria indicating data that is to be categorized and categorization criteria indicating how the data is to be categorized. Example filter criteria can include, but is not limited to, indexes (or partitions), hosts, sources, sourcetypes, time ranges, field identifier, tenant and/or user identifiers, keywords, etc.
Using the filter criteria, the query system 214 identifies relevant inverted indexes to be searched. For example, if the filter criteria includes a set of partitions (also referred to as indexes), the query system 214 can identify the inverted indexes stored in the directory corresponding to the particular partition as relevant inverted indexes. Other means can be used to identify inverted indexes associated with a partition of interest. For example, in some embodiments, the query system 214 can review an entry in the inverted indexes, such as a partition-value pair entry 2113 to determine if a particular inverted index is relevant. If the filter criteria does not identify any partition, then the query system 214 can identify all inverted indexes managed by the query system 214 as relevant inverted indexes.
Similarly, if the filter criteria includes a time range, the query system 214 can identify inverted indexes corresponding to buckets that satisfy at least a portion of the time range as relevant inverted indexes. For example, if the time range is last hour then the query system 214 can identify all inverted indexes that correspond to buckets storing events associated with timestamps within the last hour as relevant inverted indexes.
When used in combination, an index filter criterion specifying one or more partitions and a time range filter criterion specifying a particular time range can be used to identify a subset of inverted indexes within a particular directory (or otherwise associated with a particular partition) as relevant inverted indexes. As such, the query system 214 can focus the processing to only a subset of the total number of inverted indexes in the data intake and query system 108.
Once the relevant inverted indexes are identified, the query system 214 can review them using any additional filter criteria to identify events that satisfy the filter criteria. In some cases, using the known location of the directory in which the relevant inverted indexes are located, the query system 214 can determine that any events identified using the relevant inverted indexes satisfy an index filter criterion. For example, if the filter criteria includes a partition main, then the query system 214 can determine that any events identified using inverted indexes within the partition main directory (or otherwise associated with the partition main) satisfy the index filter criterion.
Furthermore, based on the time range associated with each inverted index, the query system 214 can determine that that any events identified using a particular inverted index satisfies a time range filter criterion. For example, if a time range filter criterion is for the last hour and a particular inverted index corresponds to events within a time range of 50 minutes ago to 35 minutes ago, the query system 214 can determine that any events identified using the particular inverted index satisfy the time range filter criterion. Conversely, if the particular inverted index corresponds to events within a time range of 59 minutes ago to 62 minutes ago, the query system 214 can determine that some events identified using the particular inverted index may not satisfy the time range filter criterion.
Using the inverted indexes, the query system 214 can identify event references (and therefore events) that satisfy the filter criteria. For example, if the token “error” is a filter criterion, the query system 214 can track all event references within the token entry “error.” Similarly, the query system 214 can identify other event references located in other token entries or field-value pair entries that match the filter criteria. The system can identify event references located in all of the entries identified by the filter criteria. For example, if the filter criteria include the token “error” and field-value pair sourcetype::web_ui, the query system 214 can track the event references found in both the token entry “error” and the field-value pair entry sourcetype::web_ui. As mentioned previously, in some cases, such as when multiple values are identified for a particular filter criterion (e.g., multiple sources for a source filter criterion), the system can identify event references located in at least one of the entries corresponding to the multiple values and in all other entries identified by the filter criteria. The query system 214 can determine that the events associated with the identified event references satisfy the filter criteria.
In some cases, the query system 214 can further consult a timestamp associated with the event reference to determine whether an event satisfies the filter criteria. For example, if an inverted index corresponds to a time range that is partially outside of a time range filter criterion, then the query system 214 can consult a timestamp associated with the event reference to determine whether the corresponding event satisfies the time range criterion. In some embodiments, to identify events that satisfy a time range, the query system 214 can review an array, such as the event reference array 2115 that identifies the time associated with the events. Furthermore, as mentioned above using the known location of the directory in which the relevant inverted indexes are located (or other partition identifier), the query system 214 can determine that any events identified using the relevant inverted indexes satisfy the index filter criterion.
In some cases, based on the filter criteria, the query system 214 reviews an extraction rule. In certain embodiments, if the filter criteria includes a field name that does not correspond to a field-value pair entry in an inverted index, the query system 214 can review an extraction rule, which may be located in a configuration file, to identify a field that corresponds to a field-value pair entry in the inverted index.
For example, the filter criteria includes a field name “sessionID” and the query system 214 determines that at least one relevant inverted index does not include a field-value pair entry corresponding to the field name sessionID, the query system 214 can review an extraction rule that identifies how the sessionID field is to be extracted from a particular host, source, or sourcetype (implicitly identifying the particular host, source, or sourcetype that includes a sessionID field). The query system 214 can replace the field name “sessionID” in the filter criteria with the identified host, source, or sourcetype. In some cases, the field name “sessionID” may be associated with multiples hosts, sources, or sourcetypes, in which case, all identified hosts, sources, and sourcetypes can be added as filter criteria. In some cases, the identified host, source, or sourcetype can replace or be appended to a filter criterion, or be excluded. For example, if the filter criteria includes a criterion for source S1 and the “sessionID” field is found in source S2, the source S2 can replace S1 in the filter criteria, be appended such that the filter criteria includes source S1 and source S2, or be excluded based on the presence of the filter criterion source S1. If the identified host, source, or sourcetype is included in the filter criteria, the query system 214 can then identify a field-value pair entry in the inverted index that includes a field value corresponding to the identity of the particular host, source, or sourcetype identified using the extraction rule.
Once the events that satisfy the filter criteria are identified, the query system 214 can categorize the results based on the categorization criteria. The categorization criteria can include categories for grouping the results, such as any combination of partition, source, sourcetype, or host, or other categories or fields as desired.
The query system 214 can use the categorization criteria to identify categorization criteria-value pairs or categorization criteria values by which to categorize or group the results. The categorization criteria-value pairs can correspond to one or more field-value pair entries stored in a relevant inverted index, one or more partition-value pairs based on a directory in which the inverted index is located or an entry in the inverted index (or other means by which an inverted index can be associated with a partition), or other criteria-value pair that identifies a general category and a particular value for that category. The categorization criteria values can correspond to the value portion of the categorization criteria-value pair.
As mentioned, in some cases, the categorization criteria-value pairs can correspond to one or more field-value pair entries stored in the relevant inverted indexes. For example, the categorization criteria-value pairs can correspond to field-value pair entries of host, source, and sourcetype (or other field-value pair entry as desired). For instance, if there are ten different hosts, four different sources, and five different sourcetypes for an inverted index, then the inverted index can include ten host field-value pair entries, four source field-value pair entries, and five sourcetype field-value pair entries. The query system 214 can use the nineteen distinct field-value pair entries as categorization criteria-value pairs to group the results.
Specifically, the query system 214 can identify the location of the event references associated with the events that satisfy the filter criteria within the field-value pairs, and group the event references based on their location. As such, the query system 214 can identify the particular field value associated with the event corresponding to the event reference. For example, if the categorization criteria include host and sourcetype, the host field-value pair entries and sourcetype field-value pair entries can be used as categorization criteria-value pairs to identify the specific host and sourcetype associated with the events that satisfy the filter criteria.
In addition, as mentioned, categorization criteria-value pairs can correspond to data other than the field-value pair entries in the relevant inverted indexes. For example, if partition or index is used as a categorization criterion, the inverted indexes may not include partition field-value pair entries. Rather, the query system 214 can identify the categorization criteria-value pair associated with the partition based on the directory in which an inverted index is located, information in the inverted index, or other information that associates the inverted index with the partition, etc. As such a variety of methods can be used to identify the categorization criteria-value pairs from the categorization criteria.
Accordingly based on the categorization criteria (and categorization criteria-value pairs), the query system 214 can generate groupings based on the events that satisfy the filter criteria. As a non-limiting example, if the categorization criteria includes a partition and sourcetype, then the groupings can correspond to events that are associated with each unique combination of partition and sourcetype. For instance, if there are three different partitions and two different sourcetypes associated with the identified events, then the six different groups can be formed, each with a unique partition value-sourcetype value combination. Similarly, if the categorization criteria includes partition, sourcetype, and host and there are two different partitions, three sourcetypes, and five hosts associated with the identified events, then the query system 214 can generate up to thirty groups for the results that satisfy the filter criteria. Each group can be associated with a unique combination of categorization criteria-value pairs (e.g., unique combinations of partition value sourcetype value, and host value).
In addition, the query system 214 can count the number of events associated with each group based on the number of events that meet the unique combination of categorization criteria for a particular group (or match the categorization criteria-value pairs for the particular group). With continued reference to the example above, the query system 214 can count the number of events that meet the unique combination of partition, sourcetype, and host for a particular group.
The query system 214, such as the search head 504 can aggregate the groupings from the buckets, or search nodes 506, and provide the groupings for display. In some cases, the groups are displayed based on at least one of the host, source, sourcetype, or partition associated with the groupings. In some embodiments, the query system 214 can further display the groups based on display criteria, such as a display order or a sort order as described in greater detail above.
As a non-limiting example and with reference to
Based on the above criteria, a search node 506 of the query system 214 that is associated with the data store 2101 identifies _main directory 2103 and can ignore _test directory 2105 and any other partition-specific directories. The search node 506 determines that inverted index 2107B is a relevant index based on its location within the _main directory 2103 and the time range associated with it. For sake of simplicity in this example, the search node 506 determines that no other inverted indexes in the _main directory 2103, such as inverted index 2107A satisfy the time range criterion.
Having identified the relevant inverted index 2107B, the search node 506 reviews the token entries 2111 and the field-value pair entries 2113 to identify event references, or events, that satisfy all of the filter criteria.
With respect to the token entries 2111, the search node 506 can review the error token entry and identify event references 3, 5, 6, 8, 11, 12, indicating that the term “error” is found in the corresponding events. Similarly, the search node 506 can identify event references 4, 5, 6, 8, 9, 10, 11 in the field-value pair entry sourcetype::sourcetypeC and event references 2, 5, 6, 8, 10, 11 in the field-value pair entry host::hostB. As the filter criteria did not include a source or an IP_address field-value pair, the search node 506 can ignore those field-value pair entries.
In addition to identifying event references found in at least one token entry or field-value pair entry (e.g., event references 3, 4, 5, 6, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12), the search node 506 can identify events (and corresponding event references) that satisfy the time range criterion using the event reference array 2115 (e.g., event references 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10). Using the information obtained from the inverted index 2107B (including the event reference array 2115), the search node 506 can identify the event references that satisfy all of the filter criteria (e.g., event references 5, 6, 8).
Having identified the events (and event references) that satisfy all of the filter criteria, the search node 506 can group the event references using the received categorization criteria (source). In doing so, the search node 506 can determine that event references 5 and 6 are located in the field-value pair entry source::sourceD (or have matching categorization criteria-value pairs) and event reference 8 is located in the field-value pair entry source::sourceC. Accordingly, the search node 506 can generate a sourceC group having a count of one corresponding to reference 8 and a sourceD group having a count of two corresponding to references 5 and 6. This information can be communicated to the search head 504. In turn the search head 504 can aggregate the results from the various search nodes 506 and display the groupings. As mentioned above, in some embodiments, the groupings can be displayed based at least in part on the categorization criteria, including at least one of host, source, sourcetype, or partition.
It will be understood that a change to any of the filter criteria or categorization criteria can result in different groupings. As a one non-limiting example, consider a request received by a search node 506 that includes the following filter criteria: partition=main, time range=3/1/17 3/1/17 16:21:20.000-16:28:17.000, and the following categorization criteria: host, source, sourcetype can result in the search node 506 identifying event references 1-12 as satisfying the filter criteria. The search node 506 can generate up to 24 groupings corresponding to the 24 different combinations of the categorization criteria-value pairs, including host (hostA, hostB), source (source, sourceB, sourceC, sourceD), and sourcetype (sourcetypeA, sourcetypeB, sourcetypeC). However, as there are only twelve events identifiers in the illustrated embodiment and some fall into the same grouping, the search node 506 generates eight groups and counts as follows:
Group 1 (hostA, sourceA, sourcetypeA): 1 (event reference 7)
Group 2 (hostA, sourceA, sourcetypeB): 2 (event references 1, 12)
Group 3 (hostA, sourceA, sourcetypeC): 1 (event reference 4)
Group 4 (hostA, sourceB, sourcetypeA): 1 (event reference 3)
Group 5 (hostA, sourceB, sourcetypeC): 1 (event reference 9)
Group 6 (hostB, sourceC, sourcetypeA): 1 (event reference 2)
Group 7 (hostB, sourceC, sourcetypeC): 2 (event references 8, 11)
Group 8 (hostB, sourceD, sourcetypeC): 3 (event references 5, 6, 10)
As noted, each group has a unique combination of categorization criteria-value pairs or categorization criteria values. The search node 506 communicates the groups to the search head 504 for aggregation with results received from other search nodes 506. In communicating the groups to the search head 504, the search node 506 can include the categorization criteria-value pairs for each group and the count. In some embodiments, the search node 506 can include more or less information. For example, the search node 506 can include the event references associated with each group and other identifying information, such as the search node 506 or inverted index used to identify the groups.
As another non-limiting example, consider a request received by an search node 506 that includes the following filter criteria: partition=main, time range=3/1/17 3/1/17 16:21:20.000-16:28:17.000, source=sourceA, sourceD, and keyword=itemID and the following categorization criteria: host, source, sourcetype can result in the search node identifying event references 4, 7, and 10 as satisfying the filter criteria, and generate the following groups:
Group 1 (hostA, sourceA, sourcetypeC): 1 (event reference 4)
Group 2 (hostA, sourceA, sourcetypeA): 1 (event reference 7)
Group 3 (hostB, sourceD, sourcetypeC): 1 (event references 10)
The search node 506 communicates the groups to the search head 504 for aggregation with results received from other search nodes 506. As will be understand there are myriad ways for filtering and categorizing the events and event references. For example, the search node 506 can review multiple inverted indexes associated with a partition or review the inverted indexes of multiple partitions, and categorize the data using any one or any combination of partition, host, source, sourcetype, or other category, as desired.
Further, if a user interacts with a particular group, the search node 506 can provide additional information regarding the group. For example, the search node 506 can perform a targeted search or sampling of the events that satisfy the filter criteria and the categorization criteria for the selected group, also referred to as the filter criteria corresponding to the group or filter criteria associated with the group.
In some cases, to provide the additional information, the search node 506 relies on the inverted index. For example, the search node 506 can identify the event references associated with the events that satisfy the filter criteria and the categorization criteria for the selected group and then use the event reference array 2115 to access some or all of the identified events. In some cases, the categorization criteria values or categorization criteria-value pairs associated with the group become part of the filter criteria for the review.
With reference to
In some embodiments, the search node 506 identifies the event references associated with the group using the filter criteria and the categorization criteria for the group (e.g., categorization criteria values or categorization criteria-value pairs unique to the group). Together, the filter criteria and the categorization criteria for the group can be referred to as the filter criteria associated with the group. Using the filter criteria associated with the group, the search node 506 identifies event references 4, 5, 6, 8, 10, 11.
Based on a sampling criteria, discussed in greater detail above, the search node 506 can determine that it will analyze a sample of the events associated with the event references 4, 5, 6, 8, 10, 11. For example, the sample can include analyzing event data associated with the event references 5, 8, 10. In some embodiments, the search node 506 can use the event reference array 2115 to access the event data associated with the event references 5, 8, 10. Once accessed, the search node 506 can compile the relevant information and provide it to the search head 504 for aggregation with results from other search nodes. By identifying events and sampling event data using the inverted indexes, the search node can reduce the amount of actual data this is analyzed and the number of events that are accessed in order to generate the summary of the group and provide a response in less time.
4.5. Query Processing Flow
At block 2208, the search nodes 506 to which the query was distributed, search data stores associated with them for events that are responsive to the query. To determine which events are responsive to the query, the search node 506 searches for events that match the criteria specified in the query. These criteria can include matching keywords or specific values for certain fields. The searching operations at block 2208 may use the late-binding schema to extract values for specified fields from events at the time the query is processed. In some embodiments, one or more rules for extracting field values may be specified as part of a source type definition in a configuration file. The search nodes 506 may then either send the relevant events back to the search head 504, or use the events to determine a partial result, and send the partial result back to the search head 504.
At block 2210, the search head 504 combines the partial results and/or events received from the search nodes 506 to produce a final result for the query. In some examples, the results of the query are indicative of performance or security of the IT environment and may help improve the performance of components in the IT environment. This final result may comprise different types of data depending on what the query requested. For example, the results can include a listing of matching events returned by the query, or some type of visualization of the data from the returned events. In another example, the final result can include one or more calculated values derived from the matching events.
The results generated by the system 108 can be returned to a client using different techniques. For example, one technique streams results or relevant events back to a client in real-time as they are identified. Another technique waits to report the results to the client until a complete set of results (which may include a set of relevant events or a result based on relevant events) is ready to return to the client. Yet another technique streams interim results or relevant events back to the client in real-time until a complete set of results is ready, and then returns the complete set of results to the client. In another technique, certain results are stored as “search jobs” and the client may retrieve the results by referring the search jobs.
The search head 504 can also perform various operations to make the search more efficient. For example, before the search head 504 begins execution of a query, the search head 504 can determine a time range for the query and a set of common keywords that all matching events include. The search head 504 may then use these parameters to query the search nodes 506 to obtain a superset of the eventual results. Then, during a filtering stage, the search head 504 can perform field-extraction operations on the superset to produce a reduced set of search results. This speeds up queries, which may be particularly helpful for queries that are performed on a periodic basis.
4.6. Pipelined Search Language
Various embodiments of the present disclosure can be implemented using, or in conjunction with, a pipelined command language. A pipelined command language is a language in which a set of inputs or data is operated on by a first command in a sequence of commands, and then subsequent commands in the order they are arranged in the sequence. Such commands can include any type of functionality for operating on data, such as retrieving, searching, filtering, aggregating, processing, transmitting, and the like. As described herein, a query can thus be formulated in a pipelined command language and include any number of ordered or unordered commands for operating on data.
Splunk Processing Language (SPL) is an example of a pipelined command language in which a set of inputs or data is operated on by any number of commands in a particular sequence. A sequence of commands, or command sequence, can be formulated such that the order in which the commands are arranged defines the order in which the commands are applied to a set of data or the results of an earlier executed command. For example, a first command in a command sequence can operate to search or filter for specific data in particular set of data. The results of the first command can then be passed to another command listed later in the command sequence for further processing.
In various embodiments, a query can be formulated as a command sequence defined in a command line of a search UI. In some embodiments, a query can be formulated as a sequence of SPL commands. Some or all of the SPL commands in the sequence of SPL commands can be separated from one another by a pipe symbol “|”. In such embodiments, a set of data, such as a set of events, can be operated on by a first SPL command in the sequence, and then a subsequent SPL command following a pipe symbol “|” after the first SPL command operates on the results produced by the first SPL command or other set of data, and so on for any additional SPL commands in the sequence. As such, a query formulated using SPL comprises a series of consecutive commands that are delimited by pipe “|” characters. The pipe character indicates to the system that the output or result of one command (to the left of the pipe) should be used as the input for one of the subsequent commands (to the right of the pipe). This enables formulation of queries defined by a pipeline of sequenced commands that refines or enhances the data at each step along the pipeline until the desired results are attained. Accordingly, various embodiments described herein can be implemented with Splunk Processing Language (SPL) used in conjunction with the SPLUNK® ENTERPRISE system.
While a query can be formulated in many ways, a query can start with a search command and one or more corresponding search terms at the beginning of the pipeline. Such search terms can include any combination of keywords, phrases, times, dates, Boolean expressions, fieldname-field value pairs, etc. that specify which results should be obtained from an index. The results can then be passed as inputs into subsequent commands in a sequence of commands by using, for example, a pipe character. The subsequent commands in a sequence can include directives for additional processing of the results once it has been obtained from one or more indexes. For example, commands may be used to filter unwanted information out of the results, extract more information, evaluate field values, calculate statistics, reorder the results, create an alert, create summary of the results, or perform some type of aggregation function. In some embodiments, the summary can include a graph, chart, metric, or other visualization of the data. An aggregation function can include analysis or calculations to return an aggregate value, such as an average value, a sum, a maximum value, a root mean square, statistical values, and the like.
Due to its flexible nature, use of a pipelined command language in various embodiments is advantageous because it can perform “filtering” as well as “processing” functions. In other words, a single query can include a search command and search term expressions, as well as data-analysis expressions. For example, a command at the beginning of a query can perform a “filtering” step by retrieving a set of data based on a condition (e.g., records associated with server response times of less than 1 microsecond). The results of the filtering step can then be passed to a subsequent command in the pipeline that performs a “processing” step (e.g. calculation of an aggregate value related to the filtered events such as the average response time of servers with response times of less than 1 microsecond). Furthermore, the search command can allow events to be filtered by keyword as well as field value criteria. For example, a search command can filter out all events containing the word “warning” or filter out all events where a field value associated with a field “clientip” is “10.0.1.2.”
The results obtained or generated in response to a command in a query can be considered a set of results data. The set of results data can be passed from one command to another in any data format. In one embodiment, the set of result data can be in the form of a dynamically created table. Each command in a particular query can redefine the shape of the table. In some implementations, an event retrieved from an index in response to a query can be considered a row with a column for each field value. Columns contain basic information about the data and also may contain data that has been dynamically extracted at search time.
Disk 2222 represents the event data in the raw record data store.
When a user query is processed, a search step will precede other queries in the pipeline in order to generate a set of events at block 2240. For example, the query can comprise search terms “sourcetype=syslog ERROR” at the front of the pipeline as shown in
At block 2242, the set of events generated in the first part of the query may be piped to a query that searches the set of events for field-value pairs or for keywords. For example, the second intermediate results table 2226 shows fewer columns, representing the result of the top command, “top user” which summarizes the events into a list of the top 10 users and displays the user, count, and percentage.
Finally, at block 2244, the results of the prior stage can be pipelined to another stage where further filtering or processing of the data can be performed, e.g., preparing the data for display purposes, filtering the data based on a condition, performing a mathematical calculation with the data, etc. As shown in
4.7. Field Extraction
The query system 214 allows users to search and visualize events generated from machine data received from homogenous data sources. The query system 214 also allows users to search and visualize events generated from machine data received from heterogeneous data sources. The query system 214 includes various components for processing a query, such as, but not limited to a query system manager 502, one or more search heads 504 having one or more search masters 512 and search managers 514, and one or more search nodes 506. A query language may be used to create a query, such as any suitable pipelined query language. For example, Splunk Processing Language (SPL) can be utilized to make a query. SPL is a pipelined search language in which a set of inputs is operated on by a first command in a command line, and then a subsequent command following the pipe symbol “1” operates on the results produced by the first command, and so on for additional commands. Other query languages, such as the Structured Query Language (“SQL”), can be used to create a query.
In response to receiving the search query, a search head 504 (e.g., a search master 512 or search manager 514) can use extraction rules to extract values for fields in the events being searched. The search head 504 can obtain extraction rules that specify how to extract a value for fields from an event. Extraction rules can comprise regex rules that specify how to extract values for the fields corresponding to the extraction rules. In addition to specifying how to extract field values, the extraction rules may also include instructions for deriving a field value by performing a function on a character string or value retrieved by the extraction rule. For example, an extraction rule may truncate a character string or convert the character string into a different data format. In some cases, the query itself can specify one or more extraction rules.
The search head 504 can apply the extraction rules to events that it receives from search nodes 506. The search nodes 506 may apply the extraction rules to events in an associated data store or common storage 216. Extraction rules can be applied to all the events in a data store or common storage 216 or to a subset of the events that have been filtered based on some criteria (e.g., event time stamp values, etc.). Extraction rules can be used to extract one or more values for a field from events by parsing the portions of machine data in the events and examining the data for one or more patterns of characters, numbers, delimiters, etc., that indicate where the field begins and, optionally, ends.
Using the log data received at the data intake and query system 108 from the three systems, the vendor can uniquely obtain an insight into user activity, user experience, and system behavior. The query system 214 allows the vendor's administrator to search the log data from the three systems, thereby obtaining correlated information, such as the order number and corresponding customer ID number of the person placing the order. The system also allows the administrator to see a visualization of related events via a user interface. The administrator can query the query system 214 for customer ID field value matches across the log data from the three systems that are stored in common storage 216. The customer ID field value exists in the data gathered from the three systems, but the customer ID field value may be located in different areas of the data given differences in the architecture of the systems. There is a semantic relationship between the customer ID field values generated by the three systems. The query system 214 requests events from the one or more data stores 218 to gather relevant events from the three systems. The search head 504 then applies extraction rules to the events in order to extract field values that it can correlate. The search head 504 may apply a different extraction rule to each set of events from each system when the event format differs among systems. In this example, the user interface can display to the administrator the events corresponding to the common customer ID field values 2307, 2308, and 2309, thereby providing the administrator with insight into a customer's experience.
Note that query results can be returned to a client, a search head 504, or any other system component for further processing. In general, query results may include a set of one or more events, a set of one or more values obtained from the events, a subset of the values, statistics calculated based on the values, a report containing the values, a visualization (e.g., a graph or chart) generated from the values, and the like.
The query system 214 enables users to run queries against the stored data to retrieve events that meet criteria specified in a query, such as containing certain keywords or having specific values in defined fields.
If a user inputs a search query into search bar 2310 that includes only keywords (also known as “tokens”), e.g., the keyword “error” or “warning”, the query system 214 of the data intake and query system 108 can search for those keywords directly in the event data 2311 stored in the raw record data store. Note that while
As disclosed above, the indexing system 212 can optionally generate a keyword index to facilitate fast keyword searching for event data. The indexing system 212 can include the identified keywords in an index, which associates each stored keyword with reference pointers to events containing that keyword (or to locations within events where that keyword is located, other location identifiers, etc.). When the query system 214 subsequently receives a keyword-based query, the query system 214 can access the keyword index to quickly identify events containing the keyword. For example, if the keyword “HTTP” was indexed by the indexing system 212 at index time, and the user searches for the keyword “HTTP,” the events 2312, 2313, and 2314, will be identified based on the results returned from the keyword index. As noted above, the index contains reference pointers to the events containing the keyword, which allows for efficient retrieval of the relevant events from the raw record data store.
If a user searches for a keyword that has not been indexed by the indexing system 212, the data intake and query system 108 may nevertheless be able to retrieve the events by searching the event data for the keyword in the raw record data store directly as shown in
In most cases, however, in addition to keywords, a user's search will also include fields. The term “field” refers to a location in the event data containing one or more values for a specific data item. Often, a field is a value with a fixed, delimited position on a line, or a name and value pair, where there is a single value to each field name. A field can also be multivalued, that is, it can appear more than once in an event and have a different value for each appearance, e.g., email address fields. Fields are searchable by the field name or field name-value pairs. Some examples of fields are “clientip” for IP addresses accessing a web server, or the “From” and “To” fields in email addresses.
By way of further example, consider the search, “status=404”. This search query finds events with “status” fields that have a value of “404.” When the search is run, the query system 214 does not look for events with any other “status” value. It also does not look for events containing other fields that share “404” as a value. As a result, the search returns a set of results that are more focused than if “404” had been used in the search string as part of a keyword search. Note also that fields can appear in events as “key=value” pairs such as “user_name=Bob.” But in most cases, field values appear in fixed, delimited positions without identifying keys. For example, the data store may contain events where the “user_name” value always appears by itself after the timestamp as illustrated by the following string: “November 15 09:33:22 johnmedlock.”
The data intake and query system 108 advantageously allows for search time field extraction. In other words, fields can be extracted from the event data at search time using late-binding schema as opposed to at data ingestion time, which was a major limitation of the prior art systems.
In response to receiving the search query, a search head 504 of the query system 214 can use extraction rules to extract values for the fields associated with a field or fields in the event data being searched. The search head 504 can obtain extraction rules that specify how to extract a value for certain fields from an event. Extraction rules can comprise regex rules that specify how to extract values for the relevant fields. In addition to specifying how to extract field values, the extraction rules may also include instructions for deriving a field value by performing a function on a character string or value retrieved by the extraction rule. For example, a transformation rule may truncate a character string, or convert the character string into a different data format. In some cases, the query itself can specify one or more extraction rules.
Configuration file 2316 may contain extraction rules for all the various fields that are not metadata fields, e.g., the “clientip” field. The extraction rules may be inserted into the configuration file in a variety of ways. In some embodiments, the extraction rules can comprise regular expression rules that are manually entered in by the user. Regular expressions match patterns of characters in text and are used for extracting custom fields in text.
In one or more embodiments, as noted above, a field extractor may be configured to automatically generate extraction rules for certain field values in the events when the events are being created, indexed, or stored, or possibly at a later time. In one embodiment, a user may be able to dynamically create custom fields by highlighting portions of a sample event that should be extracted as fields using a graphical user interface. The system can then generate a regular expression that extracts those fields from similar events and store the regular expression as an extraction rule for the associated field in the configuration file 2316.
In some embodiments, the indexing system 212 can automatically discover certain custom fields at index time and the regular expressions for those fields will be automatically generated at index time and stored as part of extraction rules in configuration file 2316. For example, fields that appear in the event data as “key=value” pairs may be automatically extracted as part of an automatic field discovery process. Note that there may be several other ways of adding field definitions to configuration files in addition to the methods discussed herein.
The search head 504 can apply the extraction rules derived from configuration file 2316 to event data that it receives from search nodes 506. The search nodes 506 may apply the extraction rules from the configuration file to events in an associated data store or common storage 216. Extraction rules can be applied to all the events in a data store, or to a subset of the events that have been filtered based on some criteria (e.g., event time stamp values, etc.). Extraction rules can be used to extract one or more values for a field from events by parsing the event data and examining the event data for one or more patterns of characters, numbers, delimiters, etc., that indicate where the field begins and, optionally, ends.
In one more embodiments, the extraction rule in configuration file 2316 will also need to define the type or set of events that the rule applies to. Because the raw record data store will contain events from multiple heterogeneous sources, multiple events may contain the same fields in different locations because of discrepancies in the format of the data generated by the various sources. Furthermore, certain events may not contain a particular field at all. For example, event 2315 also contains “clientip” field, however, the “clientip” field is in a different format from events 2312, 2313, and 2314. To address the discrepancies in the format and content of the different types of events, the configuration file will also need to specify the set of events that an extraction rule applies to, e.g., extraction rule 2317 specifies a rule for filtering by the type of event and contains a regular expression for parsing out the field value. Accordingly, each extraction rule can pertain to only a particular type of event. If a particular field, e.g., “clientip” occurs in multiple types of events, each of those types of events can have its own corresponding extraction rule in the configuration file 2316 and each of the extraction rules would comprise a different regular expression to parse out the associated field value. The most common way to categorize events is by source type because events generated by a particular source can have the same format.
The field extraction rules stored in configuration file 2316 perform search-time field extractions. For example, for a query that requests a list of events with source type “access_combined” where the “clientip” field equals “127.0.0.1,” the query system 214 can first locate the configuration file 2316 to retrieve extraction rule 2317 that allows it to extract values associated with the “clientip” field from the event data 2320 “where the source type is “access_combined. After the “clientip” field has been extracted from all the events comprising the “clientip” field where the source type is “access_combined,” the query system 214 can then execute the field criteria by performing the compare operation to filter out the events where the “clientip” field equals “127.0.0.1.” In the example shown in
In some embodiments, the configuration file 2316 can be created during indexing. It may either be manually created by the user or automatically generated with certain predetermined field extraction rules. As discussed above, the events may be distributed across several data stores in common storage 216, wherein various indexing nodes 404 may be responsible for storing the events in the common storage 216 and various search nodes 506 may be responsible for searching the events contained in common storage 216.
The ability to add schema to the configuration file at search time results in increased efficiency. A user can create new fields at search time and simply add field definitions to the configuration file. As a user learns more about the data in the events, the user can continue to refine the late-binding schema by adding new fields, deleting fields, or modifying the field extraction rules in the configuration file for use the next time the schema is used by the system. Because the data intake and query system 108 maintains the underlying raw data and uses late-binding schema for searching the raw data, it enables a user to continue investigating and learn valuable insights about the raw data long after data ingestion time.
The ability to add multiple field definitions to the configuration file at search time also results in increased flexibility. For example, multiple field definitions can be added to the configuration file to capture the same field across events generated by different source types. This allows the data intake and query system 108 to search and correlate data across heterogeneous sources flexibly and efficiently.
Further, by providing the field definitions for the queried fields at search time, the configuration file 2316 allows the record data store to be field searchable. In other words, the raw record data store can be searched using keywords as well as fields, wherein the fields are searchable name/value pairings that distinguish one event from another and can be defined in configuration file 2316 using extraction rules. In comparison to a search containing field names, a keyword search does not need the configuration file and can search the event data directly as shown in
It should also be noted that any events filtered out by performing a search-time field extraction using a configuration file 2316 can be further processed by directing the results of the filtering step to a processing step using a pipelined search language. Using the prior example, a user can pipeline the results of the compare step to an aggregate function by asking the query system 214 to count the number of events where the “clientip” field equals “127.0.0.1.”
4.8. Example Search Screen
After the search is executed, the search screen 2400 in
The events tab additionally displays a sidebar that is an interactive field picker 2406. The field picker 2406 may be displayed to a user in response to the search being executed and allows the user to further analyze the search results based on the fields in the events of the search results. The field picker 2406 includes field names that reference fields present in the events in the search results. The field picker may display any Selected Fields 2420 that a user has pre-selected for display (e.g., host, source, sourcetype) and may also display any Interesting Fields 2422 that the system determines may be interesting to the user based on pre-specified criteria (e.g., action, bytes, categoryid, clientip, date_hour, date_mday, date_minute, etc.). The field picker also provides an option to display field names for all the fields present in the events of the search results using the All Fields control 2424.
Each field name in the field picker 2406 has a value type identifier to the left of the field name, such as value type identifier 2426. A value type identifier identifies the type of value for the respective field, such as an “a” for fields that include literal values or a “#” for fields that include numerical values.
Each field name in the field picker also has a unique value count to the right of the field name, such as unique value count 2428. The unique value count indicates the number of unique values for the respective field in the events of the search results.
Each field name is selectable to view the events in the search results that have the field referenced by that field name. For example, a user can select the “host” field name, and the events shown in the events list 2408 will be updated with events in the search results that have the field that is reference by the field name “host.”
4.9. Data Models
A data model is a hierarchically structured search-time mapping of semantic knowledge about one or more datasets. It encodes the domain knowledge used to build a variety of specialized searches of those datasets. Those searches, in turn, can be used to generate reports.
A data model is composed of one or more “objects” (or “data model objects”) that define or otherwise correspond to a specific set of data. An object is defined by constraints and attributes. An object's constraints are search criteria that define the set of events to be operated on by running a search having that search criteria at the time the data model is selected. An object's attributes are the set of fields to be exposed for operating on that set of events generated by the search criteria.
Objects in data models can be arranged hierarchically in parent/child relationships. Each child object represents a subset of the dataset covered by its parent object. The top-level objects in data models are collectively referred to as “root objects.”
Child objects have inheritance. Child objects inherit constraints and attributes from their parent objects and may have additional constraints and attributes of their own. Child objects provide a way of filtering events from parent objects. Because a child object may provide an additional constraint in addition to the constraints it has inherited from its parent object, the dataset it represents may be a subset of the dataset that its parent represents. For example, a first data model object may define a broad set of data pertaining to e-mail activity generally, and another data model object may define specific datasets within the broad dataset, such as a subset of the e-mail data pertaining specifically to e-mails sent. For example, a user can simply select an “e-mail activity” data model object to access a dataset relating to e-mails generally (e.g., sent or received), or select an “e-mails sent” data model object (or data sub-model object) to access a dataset relating to e-mails sent.
Because a data model object is defined by its constraints (e.g., a set of search criteria) and attributes (e.g., a set of fields), a data model object can be used to quickly search data to identify a set of events and to identify a set of fields to be associated with the set of events. For example, an “e-mails sent” data model object may specify a search for events relating to e-mails that have been sent, and specify a set of fields that are associated with the events. Thus, a user can retrieve and use the “e-mails sent” data model object to quickly search source data for events relating to sent e-mails, and may be provided with a listing of the set of fields relevant to the events in a user interface screen.
Examples of data models can include electronic mail, authentication, databases, intrusion detection, malware, application state, alerts, compute inventory, network sessions, network traffic, performance, audits, updates, vulnerabilities, etc. Data models and their objects can be designed by knowledge managers in an organization, and they can enable downstream users to quickly focus on a specific set of data. A user iteratively applies a model development tool (not shown in
Data definitions in associated schemas can be taken from the common information model (CIM) or can be devised for a particular schema and optionally added to the CIM. Child objects inherit fields from parents and can include fields not present in parents. A model developer can select fewer extraction rules than are available for the sources returned by the query that defines events belonging to a model. Selecting a limited set of extraction rules can be a tool for simplifying and focusing the data model, while allowing a user flexibility to explore the data subset. Development of a data model is further explained in U.S. Pat. Nos. 8,788,525 and 8,788,526, both entitled “DATA MODEL FOR MACHINE DATA FOR SEMANTIC SEARCH”, both issued on 22 Jul. 2014, U.S. Pat. No. 8,983,994, entitled “GENERATION OF A DATA MODEL FOR SEARCHING MACHINE DATA”, issued on 17 Mar. 2015, U.S. Pat. No. 9,128,980, entitled “GENERATION OF A DATA MODEL APPLIED TO QUERIES”, issued on 8 Sep. 2015, and U.S. Pat. No. 9,589,012, entitled “GENERATION OF A DATA MODEL APPLIED TO OBJECT QUERIES”, issued on 7 Mar. 2017, each of which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety for all purposes.
A data model can also include reports. One or more report formats can be associated with a particular data model and be made available to run against the data model. A user can use child objects to design reports with object datasets that already have extraneous data pre-filtered out. In some embodiments, the data intake and query system 108 provides the user with the ability to produce reports (e.g., a table, chart, visualization, etc.) without having to enter SPL, SQL, or other query language terms into a search screen. Data models are used as the basis for the search feature.
Data models may be selected in a report generation interface. The report generator supports drag-and-drop organization of fields to be summarized in a report. When a model is selected, the fields with available extraction rules are made available for use in the report. The user may refine and/or filter search results to produce more precise reports. The user may select some fields for organizing the report and select other fields for providing detail according to the report organization. For example, “region” and “salesperson” are fields used for organizing the report and sales data can be summarized (subtotaled and totaled) within this organization. The report generator allows the user to specify one or more fields within events and apply statistical analysis on values extracted from the specified one or more fields. The report generator may aggregate search results across sets of events and generate statistics based on aggregated search results. Building reports using the report generation interface is further explained in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/503,335, entitled “GENERATING REPORTS FROM UNSTRUCTURED DATA”, filed on 30 Sep. 2014, and which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety for all purposes. Data visualizations also can be generated in a variety of formats, by reference to the data model. Reports, data visualizations, and data model objects can be saved and associated with the data model for future use. The data model object may be used to perform searches of other data.
The selection of a data model object for use in driving a report generation may be facilitated by a data model object selection interface.
Once a data model object is selected by the user, a user interface screen 2700 shown in
The reporting application allows the user to create graphical visualizations of the statistics generated for a report. For example,
4.10. Acceleration Techniques
The above-described system provides significant flexibility by enabling a user to analyze massive quantities of minimally-processed data “on the fly” at search time using a late-binding schema, instead of storing pre-specified portions of the data in a database at ingestion time. This flexibility enables a user to see valuable insights, correlate data, and perform subsequent queries to examine interesting aspects of the data that may not have been apparent at ingestion time.
However, performing extraction and analysis operations at search time can involve a large amount of data and require a large number of computational operations, which can cause delays in processing the queries. Advantageously, the data intake and query system 108 also employs a number of unique acceleration techniques that have been developed to speed up analysis operations performed at search time. These techniques include: (1) performing search operations in parallel using multiple search nodes 506; (2) using a keyword index; (3) using a high performance analytics store; and (4) accelerating the process of generating reports. These novel techniques are described in more detail below.
4.10.1. Aggregation Technique
To facilitate faster query processing, a query can be structured such that multiple search nodes 506 perform the query in parallel, while aggregation of search results from the multiple search nodes 506 is performed at the search head 504. For example,
During operation, upon receiving search query 3202, a search head 504 determines that a portion of the operations involved with the search query may be performed locally by the search head 504. The search head 504 modifies search query 3202 by substituting “stats” (create aggregate statistics over results sets received from the search nodes 506 at the search head 504) with “prestats” (create statistics by the search node 506 from local results set) to produce search query 3204, and then distributes search query 3204 to distributed search nodes 506, which are also referred to as “search peers” or “peer search nodes.” Note that search queries may generally specify search criteria or operations to be performed on events that meet the search criteria. Search queries may also specify field names, as well as search criteria for the values in the fields or operations to be performed on the values in the fields. Moreover, the search head 504 may distribute the full search query to the search peers as illustrated in
4.10.2. Keyword Index
As described above with reference to the flow charts in
4.10.3. High Performance Analytics Store
To speed up certain types of queries, some embodiments of data intake and query system 108 create a high performance analytics store, which is referred to as a “summarization table,” that contains entries for specific field-value pairs. Each of these entries keeps track of instances of a specific value in a specific field in the events and includes references to events containing the specific value in the specific field. For example, an example entry in a summarization table can keep track of occurrences of the value “94107” in a “ZIP code” field of a set of events and the entry includes references to all of the events that contain the value “94107” in the ZIP code field. This optimization technique enables the system to quickly process queries that seek to determine how many events have a particular value for a particular field. To this end, the system can examine the entry in the summarization table to count instances of the specific value in the field without having to go through the individual events or perform data extractions at search time. Also, if the system needs to process all events that have a specific field-value combination, the system can use the references in the summarization table entry to directly access the events to extract further information without having to search all of the events to find the specific field-value combination at search time.
In some embodiments, the system maintains a separate summarization table for each of the above-described time-specific buckets that stores events for a specific time range. A bucket-specific summarization table includes entries for specific field-value combinations that occur in events in the specific bucket. Alternatively, the system can maintain a summarization table for the common storage 216, one or more data stores 218 of the common storage 216, buckets cached on a search node 506, etc. The different summarization tables can include entries for the events in the common storage 216, certain data stores 218 in the common storage 216, or data stores associated with a particular search node 506, etc.
The summarization table can be populated by running a periodic query that scans a set of events to find instances of a specific field-value combination, or alternatively instances of all field-value combinations for a specific field. A periodic query can be initiated by a user, or can be scheduled to occur automatically at specific time intervals. A periodic query can also be automatically launched in response to a query that asks for a specific field-value combination.
In some cases, when the summarization tables may not cover all of the events that are relevant to a query, the system can use the summarization tables to obtain partial results for the events that are covered by summarization tables, but may also have to search through other events that are not covered by the summarization tables to produce additional results. These additional results can then be combined with the partial results to produce a final set of results for the query. The summarization table and associated techniques are described in more detail in U.S. Pat. No. 8,682,925, entitled “DISTRIBUTED HIGH PERFORMANCE ANALYTICS STORE”, issued on 25 Mar. 2014, U.S. Pat. No. 9,128,985, entitled “SUPPLEMENTING A HIGH PERFORMANCE ANALYTICS STORE WITH EVALUATION OF INDIVIDUAL EVENTS TO RESPOND TO AN EVENT QUERY”, issued on 8 Sep. 2015, and U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/815,973, entitled “GENERATING AND STORING SUMMARIZATION TABLES FOR SETS OF SEARCHABLE EVENTS”, filed on 1 Aug. 2015, each of which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety for all purposes.
To speed up certain types of queries, e.g., frequently encountered queries or computationally intensive queries, some embodiments of data intake and query system 108 create a high performance analytics store, which is referred to as a “summarization table,” (also referred to as a “lexicon” or “inverted index”) that contains entries for specific field-value pairs. Each of these entries keeps track of instances of a specific value in a specific field in the event data and includes references to events containing the specific value in the specific field. For example, an example entry in an inverted index can keep track of occurrences of the value “94107” in a “ZIP code” field of a set of events and the entry includes references to all of the events that contain the value “94107” in the ZIP code field. Creating the inverted index data structure avoids needing to incur the computational overhead each time a statistical query needs to be run on a frequently encountered field-value pair. In order to expedite queries, in certain embodiments, the query system 214 can employ the inverted index separate from the raw record data store to generate responses to the received queries.
Note that the term “summarization table” or “inverted index” as used herein is a data structure that may be generated by the indexing system 212 that includes at least field names and field values that have been extracted and/or indexed from event records. An inverted index may also include reference values that point to the location(s) in the field searchable data store where the event records that include the field may be found. Also, an inverted index may be stored using various compression techniques to reduce its storage size.
Further, note that the term “reference value” (also referred to as a “posting value”) as used herein is a value that references the location of a source record in the field searchable data store. In some embodiments, the reference value may include additional information about each record, such as timestamps, record size, meta-data, or the like. Each reference value may be a unique identifier which may be used to access the event data directly in the field searchable data store. In some embodiments, the reference values may be ordered based on each event record's timestamp. For example, if numbers are used as identifiers, they may be sorted so event records having a later timestamp always have a lower valued identifier than event records with an earlier timestamp, or vice-versa. Reference values are often included in inverted indexes for retrieving and/or identifying event records.
In one or more embodiments, an inverted index is generated in response to a user-initiated collection query. The term “collection query” as used herein refers to queries that include commands that generate summarization information and inverted indexes (or summarization tables) from event records stored in the field searchable data store.
Note that a collection query is a special type of query that can be user-generated and is used to create an inverted index. A collection query is not the same as a query that is used to call up or invoke a pre-existing inverted index. In one or more embodiments, a query can comprise an initial step that calls up a pre-generated inverted index on which further filtering and processing can be performed. For example, referring back to
In one or more embodiments, if one or more of the queries is a collection query, the one or more search nodes 506 may generate summarization information based on the fields of the event records located in the field searchable data store. In at least one of the various embodiments, one or more of the fields used in the summarization information may be listed in the collection query and/or they may be determined based on terms included in the collection query. For example, a collection query may include an explicit list of fields to summarize. Or, in at least one of the various embodiments, a collection query may include terms or expressions that explicitly define the fields, e.g., using regex rules. In
In one or more embodiments, collection queries may be saved and scheduled to run periodically. These scheduled collection queries may periodically update the summarization information corresponding to the query. For example, if the collection query that generates inverted index 2322 is scheduled to run periodically, one or more search nodes 506 can periodically search through the relevant buckets to update inverted index 2322 with event data for any new events with the “clientip” value of “127.0.0.1.”
In some embodiments, the inverted indexes that include fields, values, and reference value (e.g., inverted index 2322) for event records may be included in the summarization information provided to the user. In other embodiments, a user may not be interested in specific fields and values contained in the inverted index, but may need to perform a statistical query on the data in the inverted index. For example, referencing the example of
The pipelined search language, e.g., SPL of the SPLUNK® ENTERPRISE system can be used to pipe the contents of an inverted index to a statistical query using the “stats” command for example. A “stats” query refers to queries that generate result sets that may produce aggregate and statistical results from event records, e.g., average, mean, max, min, rms, etc. Where sufficient information is available in an inverted index, a “stats” query may generate their result sets rapidly from the summarization information available in the inverted index rather than directly scanning event records. For example, the contents of inverted index 2322 can be pipelined to a stats query, e.g., a “count” function that counts the number of entries in the inverted index and returns a value of “4.” In this way, inverted indexes may enable various stats queries to be performed absent scanning or search the event records. Accordingly, this optimization technique enables the system to quickly process queries that seek to determine how many events have a particular value for a particular field. To this end, the system can examine the entry in the inverted index to count instances of the specific value in the field without having to go through the individual events or perform data extractions at search time.
In some embodiments, the system maintains a separate inverted index for each of the above-described time-specific buckets that stores events for a specific time range. A bucket-specific inverted index includes entries for specific field-value combinations that occur in events in the specific bucket. Alternatively, the system can maintain a separate inverted index for one or more data stores 218 of common storage 216, an indexing node 404, or a search node 506. The specific inverted indexes can include entries for the events in the one or more data stores 218 or data store associated with the indexing nodes 404 or search node 506. In some embodiments, if one or more of the queries is a stats query, a search node 506 can generate a partial result set from previously generated summarization information. The partial result sets may be returned to the search head 504 that received the query and combined into a single result set for the query.
As mentioned above, the inverted index can be populated by running a periodic query that scans a set of events to find instances of a specific field-value combination, or alternatively instances of all field-value combinations for a specific field. A periodic query can be initiated by a user, or can be scheduled to occur automatically at specific time intervals. A periodic query can also be automatically launched in response to a query that asks for a specific field-value combination. In some embodiments, if summarization information is absent from a search node 506 that includes responsive event records, further actions may be taken, such as, the summarization information may generated on the fly, warnings may be provided the user, the collection query operation may be halted, the absence of summarization information may be ignored, or the like, or combination thereof.
In one or more embodiments, an inverted index may be set up to update continually. For example, the query may ask for the inverted index to update its result periodically, e.g., every hour. In such instances, the inverted index may be a dynamic data structure that is regularly updated to include information regarding incoming events.
4.10.3.1. Extracting Event Data Using Posting
In one or more embodiments, if the system needs to process all events that have a specific field-value combination, the system can use the references in the inverted index entry to directly access the events to extract further information without having to search all of the events to find the specific field-value combination at search time. In other words, the system can use the reference values to locate the associated event data in the field searchable data store and extract further information from those events, e.g., extract further field values from the events for purposes of filtering or processing or both.
The information extracted from the event data using the reference values can be directed for further filtering or processing in a query using the pipeline search language. The pipelined search language will, in one embodiment, include syntax that can direct the initial filtering step in a query to an inverted index. In one embodiment, a user would include syntax in the query that explicitly directs the initial searching or filtering step to the inverted index.
Referencing the example in
In one embodiment, the same methodology can be used to pipe the contents of the inverted index to a processing step. In other words, the user is able to use the inverted index to efficiently and quickly perform aggregate functions on field values that were not part of the initially generated inverted index. For example, a user may want to determine an average object size (size of the requested gif) requested by clients from IP address “127.0.0.1.” In this case, the query system 214 can again use the reference values stored in inverted index 2322 to retrieve the event data from the field searchable data store and, further, extract the object size field values from the associated events 2331, 2332, 2333 and 2334. Once, the corresponding object sizes have been extracted (i.e. 2326, 2900, 2920, and 5000), the average can be computed and returned to the user.
In one embodiment, instead of explicitly invoking the inverted index in a user-generated query, e.g., by the use of special commands or syntax, the SPLUNK® ENTERPRISE system can be configured to automatically determine if any prior-generated inverted index can be used to expedite a user query. For example, the user's query may request the average object size (size of the requested gif) requested by clients from IP address “127.0.0.1.” without any reference to or use of inverted index 2322. The query system 214, in this case, can automatically determine that an inverted index 2322 already exists in the system that could expedite this query. In one embodiment, prior to running any search comprising a field-value pair, for example, a query system 214 can search though all the existing inverted indexes to determine if a pre-generated inverted index could be used to expedite the search comprising the field-value pair. Accordingly, the query system 214 can automatically use the pre-generated inverted index, e.g., index 2322 to generate the results without any user-involvement that directs the use of the index.
Using the reference values in an inverted index to be able to directly access the event data in the field searchable data store and extract further information from the associated event data for further filtering and processing is highly advantageous because it avoids incurring the computation overhead of regenerating the inverted index with additional fields or performing a new search.
The data intake and query system 108 includes an intake system 210 that receives data from a variety of input data sources, and an indexing system 212 that processes and stores the data in one or more data stores or common storage 216. By distributing events among the data stores 218 of common storage 213, the query system 214 can analyze events for a query in parallel. In some embodiments, the data intake and query system 108 can maintain a separate and respective inverted index for each of the above-described time-specific buckets that stores events for a specific time range. A bucket-specific inverted index includes entries for specific field-value combinations that occur in events in the specific bucket. As explained above, a search head 504 can correlate and synthesize data from across the various buckets and search nodes 506.
This feature advantageously expedites searches because instead of performing a computationally intensive search in a centrally located inverted index that catalogues all the relevant events, a search node 506 is able to directly search an inverted index stored in a bucket associated with the time-range specified in the query. This allows the search to be performed in parallel across the various search nodes 506. Further, if the query requests further filtering or processing to be conducted on the event data referenced by the locally stored bucket-specific inverted index, the search node 506 is able to simply access the event records stored in the associated bucket for further filtering and processing instead of needing to access a central repository of event records, which would dramatically add to the computational overhead.
In one embodiment, there may be multiple buckets associated with the time-range specified in a query. If the query is directed to an inverted index, or if the query system 214 automatically determines that using an inverted index can expedite the processing of the query, the search nodes 506 can search through each of the inverted indexes associated with the buckets for the specified time-range. This feature allows the High Performance Analytics Store to be scaled easily.
At block 2342, a query is received by a data intake and query system 108. In some embodiments, the query can be received as a user generated query entered into search bar of a graphical user search interface. The search interface also includes a time range control element that enables specification of a time range for the query.
At block 2344, an inverted index is retrieved. Note, that the inverted index can be retrieved in response to an explicit user search command inputted as part of the user generated query. Alternatively, a query system 215 can be configured to automatically use an inverted index if it determines that using the inverted index would expedite the servicing of the user generated query. Each of the entries in an inverted index keeps track of instances of a specific value in a specific field in the event data and includes references to events containing the specific value in the specific field. In order to expedite queries, in some embodiments, the query system 214 employs the inverted index separate from the raw record data store to generate responses to the received queries.
At block 2346, the query system 214 determines if the query contains further filtering and processing steps. If the query contains no further commands, then, in one embodiment, summarization information can be provided to the user at block 2354.
If, however, the query does contain further filtering and processing commands, then at block 2348, the query system 214 determines if the commands relate to further filtering or processing of the data extracted as part of the inverted index or whether the commands are directed to using the inverted index as an initial filtering step to further filter and process event data referenced by the entries in the inverted index. If the query can be completed using data already in the generated inverted index, then the further filtering or processing steps, e.g., a “count” number of records function, “average” number of records per hour etc. are performed and the results are provided to the user at block 2350.
If, however, the query references fields that are not extracted in the inverted index, the query system 214 can access event data pointed to by the reference values in the inverted index to retrieve any further information required at block 2356. Subsequently, any further filtering or processing steps are performed on the fields extracted directly from the event data and the results are provided to the user at step 2358.
4.10.4. Accelerating Report Generation
In some embodiments, a data server system such as the data intake and query system 108 can accelerate the process of periodically generating updated reports based on query results. To accelerate this process, a summarization engine can automatically examine the query to determine whether generation of updated reports can be accelerated by creating intermediate summaries. If reports can be accelerated, the summarization engine periodically generates a summary covering data obtained during a latest non-overlapping time period. For example, where the query seeks events meeting a specified criteria, a summary for the time period includes may only events within the time period that meet the specified criteria. Similarly, if the query seeks statistics calculated from the events, such as the number of events that match the specified criteria, then the summary for the time period includes the number of events in the period that match the specified criteria.
In addition to the creation of the summaries, the summarization engine schedules the periodic updating of the report associated with the query. During each scheduled report update, the query system 214 determines whether intermediate summaries have been generated covering portions of the time period covered by the report update. If so, then the report is generated based on the information contained in the summaries. Also, if additional event data has been received and has not yet been summarized, and is required to generate the complete report, the query can be run on these additional events. Then, the results returned by this query on the additional events, along with the partial results obtained from the intermediate summaries, can be combined to generate the updated report. This process is repeated each time the report is updated. Alternatively, if the system stores events in buckets covering specific time ranges, then the summaries can be generated on a bucket-by-bucket basis. Note that producing intermediate summaries can save the work involved in re-running the query for previous time periods, so advantageously only the newer events needs to be processed while generating an updated report. These report acceleration techniques are described in more detail in U.S. Pat. No. 8,589,403, entitled “COMPRESSED JOURNALING IN EVENT TRACKING FILES FOR METADATA RECOVERY AND REPLICATION”, issued on 19 Nov. 2013, U.S. Pat. No. 8,412,696, entitled “REAL TIME SEARCHING AND REPORTING”, issued on 2 Apr. 2011, and U.S. Pat. Nos. 8,589,375 and 8,589,432, both also entitled “REAL TIME SEARCHING AND REPORTING”, both issued on 19 Nov. 2013, each of which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety for all purposes. 4.12. SECURITY FEATURES
The data intake and query system 108 provides various schemas, dashboards, and visualizations that simplify developers' tasks to create applications with additional capabilities. One such application is the an enterprise security application, such as SPLUNK® ENTERPRISE SECURITY, which performs monitoring and alerting operations and includes analytics to facilitate identifying both known and unknown security threats based on large volumes of data stored by the data intake and query system 108. The enterprise security application provides the security practitioner with visibility into security-relevant threats found in the enterprise infrastructure by capturing, monitoring, and reporting on data from enterprise security devices, systems, and applications. Through the use of the data intake and query system 108 searching and reporting capabilities, the enterprise security application provides a top-down and bottom-up view of an organization's security posture.
The enterprise security application leverages the data intake and query system 108 search-time normalization techniques, saved searches, and correlation searches to provide visibility into security-relevant threats and activity and generate notable events for tracking. The enterprise security application enables the security practitioner to investigate and explore the data to find new or unknown threats that do not follow signature-based patterns.
Conventional Security Information and Event Management (SIEM) systems lack the infrastructure to effectively store and analyze large volumes of security-related data. Traditional SIEM systems typically use fixed schemas to extract data from pre-defined security-related fields at data ingestion time and store the extracted data in a relational database. This traditional data extraction process (and associated reduction in data size) that occurs at data ingestion time inevitably hampers future incident investigations that may need original data to determine the root cause of a security issue, or to detect the onset of an impending security threat.
In contrast, the enterprise security application system stores large volumes of minimally-processed security-related data at ingestion time for later retrieval and analysis at search time when a live security threat is being investigated. To facilitate this data retrieval process, the enterprise security application provides pre-specified schemas for extracting relevant values from the different types of security-related events and enables a user to define such schemas.
The enterprise security application can process many types of security-related information. In general, this security-related information can include any information that can be used to identify security threats. For example, the security-related information can include network-related information, such as IP addresses, domain names, asset identifiers, network traffic volume, uniform resource locator strings, and source addresses. The process of detecting security threats for network-related information is further described in U.S. Pat. No. 8,826,434, entitled “SECURITY THREAT DETECTION BASED ON INDICATIONS IN BIG DATA OF ACCESS TO NEWLY REGISTERED DOMAINS”, issued on 2 Sep. 2014, U.S. Pat. No. 9,215,240, entitled “INVESTIGATIVE AND DYNAMIC DETECTION OF POTENTIAL SECURITY-THREAT INDICATORS FROM EVENTS IN BIG DATA”, issued on 15 Dec. 2015, U.S. Pat. No. 9,173,801, entitled “GRAPHIC DISPLAY OF SECURITY THREATS BASED ON INDICATIONS OF ACCESS TO NEWLY REGISTERED DOMAINS”, issued on 3 Nov. 2015, U.S. Pat. No. 9,248,068, entitled “SECURITY THREAT DETECTION OF NEWLY REGISTERED DOMAINS”, issued on 2 Feb. 2016, U.S. Pat. No. 9,426,172, entitled “SECURITY THREAT DETECTION USING DOMAIN NAME ACCESSES”, issued on 23 Aug. 2016, and U.S. Pat. No. 9,432,396, entitled “SECURITY THREAT DETECTION USING DOMAIN NAME REGISTRATIONS”, issued on 30 Aug. 2016, each of which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety for all purposes. Security-related information can also include malware infection data and system configuration information, as well as access control information, such as login/logout information and access failure notifications. The security-related information can originate from various sources within a data center, such as hosts, virtual machines, storage devices and sensors. The security-related information can also originate from various sources in a network, such as routers, switches, email servers, proxy servers, gateways, firewalls and intrusion-detection systems.
During operation, the enterprise security application facilitates detecting “notable events” that are likely to indicate a security threat. A notable event represents one or more anomalous incidents, the occurrence of which can be identified based on one or more events (e.g., time stamped portions of raw machine data) fulfilling pre-specified and/or dynamically-determined (e.g., based on machine-learning) criteria defined for that notable event. Examples of notable events include the repeated occurrence of an abnormal spike in network usage over a period of time, a single occurrence of unauthorized access to system, a host communicating with a server on a known threat list, and the like. These notable events can be detected in a number of ways, such as: (1) a user can notice a correlation in events and can manually identify that a corresponding group of one or more events amounts to a notable event; or (2) a user can define a “correlation search” specifying criteria for a notable event, and every time one or more events satisfy the criteria, the application can indicate that the one or more events correspond to a notable event; and the like. A user can alternatively select a pre-defined correlation search provided by the application. Note that correlation searches can be run continuously or at regular intervals (e.g., every hour) to search for notable events. Upon detection, notable events can be stored in a dedicated “notable events index,” which can be subsequently accessed to generate various visualizations containing security-related information. Also, alerts can be generated to notify system operators when important notable events are discovered.
The enterprise security application provides various visualizations to aid in discovering security threats, such as a “key indicators view” that enables a user to view security metrics, such as counts of different types of notable events. It can also display a change in a metric value, which indicates that the number of malware infections increased by 63 during the preceding interval. Key indicators view additionally displays a histogram panel that displays a histogram of notable events organized by urgency values, and a histogram of notable events organized by time intervals. This key indicators view is described in further detail in pending U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/956,338, entitled “KEY INDICATORS VIEW”, filed on 31 Jul. 2013, and which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety for all purposes.
These visualizations can also include an “incident review dashboard” that enables a user to view and act on “notable events.” These notable events can include: (1) a single event of high importance, such as any activity from a known web attacker; or (2) multiple events that collectively warrant review, such as a large number of authentication failures on a host followed by a successful authentication. It also includes a timeline that graphically illustrates the number of incidents that occurred in time intervals over the selected time range. It additionally displays an events list that enables a user to view a list of all of the notable events that match the criteria in the incident attributes fields. To facilitate identifying patterns among the notable events, each notable event can be associated with an urgency value (e.g., low, medium, high, critical), which is indicated in the incident review dashboard. The urgency value for a detected event can be determined based on the severity of the event and the priority of the system component associated with the event.
4.13. Data Center Monitoring
As mentioned above, the data intake and query platform provides various features that simplify the developer's task to create various applications. One such application is a virtual machine monitoring application, such as SPLUNK® APP FOR VMWARE® that provides operational visibility into granular performance metrics, logs, tasks and events, and topology from hosts, virtual machines and virtual centers. It empowers administrators with an accurate real-time picture of the health of the environment, proactively identifying performance and capacity bottlenecks.
Conventional data-center-monitoring systems lack the infrastructure to effectively store and analyze large volumes of machine-generated data, such as performance information and log data obtained from the data center. In conventional data-center-monitoring systems, machine-generated data is typically pre-processed prior to being stored, for example, by extracting pre-specified data items and storing them in a database to facilitate subsequent retrieval and analysis at search time. However, the rest of the data is not saved and discarded during pre-processing.
In contrast, the virtual machine monitoring application stores large volumes of minimally processed machine data, such as performance information and log data, at ingestion time for later retrieval and analysis at search time when a live performance issue is being investigated. In addition to data obtained from various log files, this performance-related information can include values for performance metrics obtained through an application programming interface (API) provided as part of the vSphere Hypervisor™ system distributed by VMware, Inc. of Palo Alto, Calif. For example, these performance metrics can include: (1) CPU-related performance metrics; (2) disk-related performance metrics; (3) memory-related performance metrics; (4) network-related performance metrics; (5) energy-usage statistics; (6) data-traffic-related performance metrics; (7) overall system availability performance metrics; (8) cluster-related performance metrics; and (9) virtual machine performance statistics. Such performance metrics are described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/167,316, entitled “CORRELATION FOR USER-SELECTED TIME RANGES OF VALUES FOR PERFORMANCE METRICS OF COMPONENTS IN AN INFORMATION-TECHNOLOGY ENVIRONMENT WITH LOG DATA FROM THAT INFORMATION-TECHNOLOGY ENVIRONMENT”, filed on 29 Jan. 2014, and which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety for all purposes.
To facilitate retrieving information of interest from performance data and log files, the virtual machine monitoring application provides pre-specified schemas for extracting relevant values from different types of performance-related events, and also enables a user to define such schemas.
The virtual machine monitoring application additionally provides various visualizations to facilitate detecting and diagnosing the root cause of performance problems. For example, one such visualization is a “proactive monitoring tree” that enables a user to easily view and understand relationships among various factors that affect the performance of a hierarchically structured computing system. This proactive monitoring tree enables a user to easily navigate the hierarchy by selectively expanding nodes representing various entities (e.g., virtual centers or computing clusters) to view performance information for lower-level nodes associated with lower-level entities (e.g., virtual machines or host systems). The ease of navigation provided by selective expansion in combination with the associated performance-state information enables a user to quickly diagnose the root cause of a performance problem. The proactive monitoring tree is described in further detail in U.S. Pat. No. 9,185,007, entitled “PROACTIVE MONITORING TREE WITH SEVERITY STATE SORTING,” issued on 10 Nov. 2015, and U.S. Pat. No. 9,426,045, also entitled “PROACTIVE MONITORING TREE WITH SEVERITY STATE SORTING,” issued on 23 Aug. 2016, each of which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety for all purposes.
The virtual machine monitoring application also provides a user interface that enables a user to select a specific time range and then view heterogeneous data comprising events, log data, and associated performance metrics for the selected time range. This enables the user to correlate trends in the performance-metric graph with corresponding event and log data to quickly determine the root cause of a performance problem. This user interface is described in more detail in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/167,316, entitled “CORRELATION FOR USER-SELECTED TIME RANGES OF VALUES FOR PERFORMANCE METRICS OF COMPONENTS IN AN INFORMATION-TECHNOLOGY ENVIRONMENT WITH LOG DATA FROM THAT INFORMATION-TECHNOLOGY ENVIRONMENT”, filed on 29 Jan. 2014, and which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety for all purposes.
4.14. IT Service Monitoring
As previously mentioned, the data intake and query platform provides various schemas, dashboards and visualizations that make it easy for developers to create applications to provide additional capabilities. One such application is an IT monitoring application, such as SPLUNK® IT SERVICE INTELLIGENCE™, which performs monitoring and alerting operations. The IT monitoring application also includes analytics to help an analyst diagnose the root cause of performance problems based on large volumes of data stored by the data intake and query system 108 as correlated to the various services an IT organization provides (a service-centric view). This differs significantly from conventional IT monitoring systems that lack the infrastructure to effectively store and analyze large volumes of service-related events. Traditional service monitoring systems typically use fixed schemas to extract data from pre-defined fields at data ingestion time, wherein the extracted data is typically stored in a relational database. This data extraction process and associated reduction in data content that occurs at data ingestion time inevitably hampers future investigations, when all of the original data may be needed to determine the root cause of or contributing factors to a service issue.
In contrast, an IT monitoring application system stores large volumes of minimally-processed service-related data at ingestion time for later retrieval and analysis at search time, to perform regular monitoring, or to investigate a service issue. To facilitate this data retrieval process, the IT monitoring application enables a user to define an IT operations infrastructure from the perspective of the services it provides. In this service-centric approach, a service such as corporate e-mail may be defined in terms of the entities employed to provide the service, such as host machines and network devices. Each entity is defined to include information for identifying all of the events that pertains to the entity, whether produced by the entity itself or by another machine, and considering the many various ways the entity may be identified in machine data (such as by a URL, an IP address, or machine name). The service and entity definitions can organize events around a service so that all of the events pertaining to that service can be easily identified. This capability provides a foundation for the implementation of Key Performance Indicators.
One or more Key Performance Indicators (KPI's) are defined for a service within the IT monitoring application. Each KPI measures an aspect of service performance at a point in time or over a period of time (aspect KPI's). Each KPI is defined by a search query that derives a KPI value from the machine data of events associated with the entities that provide the service. Information in the entity definitions may be used to identify the appropriate events at the time a KPI is defined or whenever a KPI value is being determined. The KPI values derived over time may be stored to build a valuable repository of current and historical performance information for the service, and the repository, itself, may be subject to search query processing. Aggregate KPIs may be defined to provide a measure of service performance calculated from a set of service aspect KPI values; this aggregate may even be taken across defined timeframes and/or across multiple services. A particular service may have an aggregate KPI derived from substantially all of the aspect KPI's of the service to indicate an overall health score for the service.
The IT monitoring application facilitates the production of meaningful aggregate KPI's through a system of KPI thresholds and state values. Different KPI definitions may produce values in different ranges, and so the same value may mean something very different from one KPI definition to another. To address this, the IT monitoring application implements a translation of individual KPI values to a common domain of “state” values. For example, a KPI range of values may be 1-100, or 50-275, while values in the state domain may be ‘critical,’ ‘warning,’ ‘normal,’ and ‘informational’. Thresholds associated with a particular KPI definition determine ranges of values for that KPI that correspond to the various state values. In one case, KPI values 95-100 may be set to correspond to ‘critical’ in the state domain. KPI values from disparate KPI's can be processed uniformly once they are translated into the common state values using the thresholds. For example, “normal 80% of the time” can be applied across various KPI's. To provide meaningful aggregate KPI's, a weighting value can be assigned to each KPI so that its influence on the calculated aggregate KPI value is increased or decreased relative to the other KPI's.
One service in an IT environment often impacts, or is impacted by, another service. The IT monitoring application can reflect these dependencies. For example, a dependency relationship between a corporate e-mail service and a centralized authentication service can be reflected by recording an association between their respective service definitions. The recorded associations establish a service dependency topology that informs the data or selection options presented in a GUI, for example. (The service dependency topology is like a “map” showing how services are connected based on their dependencies.) The service topology may itself be depicted in a GUI and may be interactive to allow navigation among related services.
Entity definitions in the IT monitoring application can include informational fields that can serve as metadata, implied data fields, or attributed data fields for the events identified by other aspects of the entity definition. Entity definitions in the IT monitoring application can also be created and updated by an import of tabular data (as represented in a CSV, another delimited file, or a search query result set). The import may be GUI-mediated or processed using import parameters from a GUI-based import definition process. Entity definitions in the IT monitoring application can also be associated with a service by means of a service definition rule. Processing the rule results in the matching entity definitions being associated with the service definition. The rule can be processed at creation time, and thereafter on a scheduled or on-demand basis. This allows dynamic, rule-based updates to the service definition.
During operation, the IT monitoring application can recognize notable events that may indicate a service performance problem or other situation of interest. These notable events can be recognized by a “correlation search” specifying trigger criteria for a notable event: every time KPI values satisfy the criteria, the application indicates a notable event. A severity level for the notable event may also be specified. Furthermore, when trigger criteria are satisfied, the correlation search may additionally or alternatively cause a service ticket to be created in an IT service management (ITSM) system, such as systems available from ServiceNow, Inc., of Santa Clara, Calif.
SPLUNK® IT SERVICE INTELLIGENCE™ provides various visualizations built on its service-centric organization of events and the KPI values generated and collected. Visualizations can be particularly useful for monitoring or investigating service performance. The IT monitoring application provides a service monitoring interface suitable as the home page for ongoing IT service monitoring. The interface is appropriate for settings such as desktop use or for a wall-mounted display in a network operations center (NOC). The interface may prominently display a services health section with tiles for the aggregate KPI's indicating overall health for defined services and a general KPI section with tiles for KPI's related to individual service aspects. These tiles may display KPI information in a variety of ways, such as by being colored and ordered according to factors like the KPI state value. They also can be interactive and navigate to visualizations of more detailed KPI information.
The IT monitoring application provides a service-monitoring dashboard visualization based on a user-defined template. The template can include user-selectable widgets of varying types and styles to display KPI information. The content and the appearance of widgets can respond dynamically to changing KPI information. The KPI widgets can appear in conjunction with a background image, user drawing objects, or other visual elements, that depict the IT operations environment, for example. The KPI widgets or other GUI elements can be interactive so as to provide navigation to visualizations of more detailed KPI information.
The IT monitoring application provides a visualization showing detailed time-series information for multiple KPI's in parallel graph lanes. The length of each lane can correspond to a uniform time range, while the width of each lane may be automatically adjusted to fit the displayed KPI data. Data within each lane may be displayed in a user selectable style, such as a line, area, or bar chart. During operation a user may select a position in the time range of the graph lanes to activate lane inspection at that point in time. Lane inspection may display an indicator for the selected time across the graph lanes and display the KPI value associated with that point in time for each of the graph lanes. The visualization may also provide navigation to an interface for defining a correlation search, using information from the visualization to pre-populate the definition.
The IT monitoring application provides a visualization for incident review showing detailed information for notable events. The incident review visualization may also show summary information for the notable events over a time frame, such as an indication of the number of notable events at each of a number of severity levels. The severity level display may be presented as a rainbow chart with the warmest color associated with the highest severity classification. The incident review visualization may also show summary information for the notable events over a time frame, such as the number of notable events occurring within segments of the time frame. The incident review visualization may display a list of notable events within the time frame ordered by any number of factors, such as time or severity. The selection of a particular notable event from the list may display detailed information about that notable event, including an identification of the correlation search that generated the notable event.
The IT monitoring application provides pre-specified schemas for extracting relevant values from the different types of service-related events. It also enables a user to define such schemas.
4.15. Other Architectures
In view of the description above, it will be appreciate that the architecture disclosed herein, or elements of that architecture, may be implemented independently from, or in conjunction with, other architectures. For example, the Parent Applications disclose a variety of architectures wholly or partially compatible with the architecture of the present disclosure.
Generally speaking one or more components of the data intake and query system 108 of the present disclosure can be used in combination with or to replace one or more components of the data intake and query system 108 of the Parent Applications. For example, depending on the embodiment, the operations of the forwarder 204 and the ingestion buffer 4802 of the Parent Applications can be performed by or replaced with the intake system 210 of the present disclosure. The parsing, indexing, and storing operations (or other non-searching operations) of the indexers 206, 230 and indexing cache components 254 of the Parent Applications can be performed by or replaced with the indexing nodes 404 of the present disclosure. The storage operations of the data stores 208 of the Parent Applications can be performed using the data stores 412 of the present disclosure (in some cases with the data not being moved to common storage 216). The storage operations of the common storage 4602, cloud storage 256, or global index 258 can be performed by the common storage 216 of the present disclosure. The storage operations of the query acceleration data store 3308 can be performed by the query acceleration data store 222 of the present disclosure.
As continuing examples, the search operations of the indexers 206, 230 and indexing cache components 254 of the Parent Applications can be performed by or replaced with the indexing nodes 404 in some embodiments or by the search nodes 506 in certain embodiments. For example, in some embodiments of certain architectures of the Parent Applications (e.g., one or more embodiments related to FIGS. 2, 3, 4, 18, 25, 27), the indexers 206, 230 and indexing cache components 254 of the Parent Applications may perform parsing, indexing, storing, and at least some searching operations, and in embodiments of some architectures of the Parent Applications, indexers 206, 230 and indexing cache components 254 of the Parent Applications perform parsing, indexing, and storing operations, but do not perform searching operations. Accordingly, in some embodiments, some or all of the searching operations described as being performed by the indexers 206, 230 and indexing cache components 254 of the Parent Applications can be performed by the search nodes 506. For example, in embodiments described in the Parent Applications in which worker nodes 214, 236, 246, 3306 perform searching operations in place of the indexers 206, 230 or indexing cache components 254, the search nodes 506 can perform those operations. In certain embodiments, some or all of the searching operations described as being performed by the indexers 206, 230 and indexing cache components 254 of the Parent Applications can be performed by the indexing nodes 404. For example, in embodiments described in the Parent Applications in which the indexers 206, 230 and indexing cache components 254 perform searching operations, the indexing nodes 404 can perform those operations.
As a further example, the query operations performed by the search heads 210, 226, 244, daemons 210, 232, 252, search master 212, 234, 250, search process master 3302, search service provider 216, and query coordinator 3304 of the Parent Applications, can be performed by or replaced with any one or any combination of the query system manager 502, search head 504, search master 512, search manager 514, search node monitor 508, and/or the search node catalog 510. For example, these components can handle and coordinate the intake of queries, query processing, identification of available nodes and resources, resource allocation, query execution plan generation, assignment of query operations, combining query results, and providing query results to a user or a data store.
In certain embodiments, the query operations performed by the worker nodes 214, 236, 246, 3306 of the Parent Applications can be performed by or replaced with the search nodes 506 of the present disclosure. In some embodiments, the intake or ingestion operations performed by the worker nodes 214, 236, 246, 3306 of the Parent Applications can be performed by or replaced with one or more components of the intake system 210.
Furthermore, it will be understood that some or all of the components of the architectures of the Parent Applications can be replaced with components of the present disclosure. For example, in certain embodiments, the intake system 210 can be used in place of the forwarders 204 and/or ingestion buffer 4802 of one or more architectures of the Parent Applications, with all other components of the one or more architecture of the Parent Applications remaining the same. As another example, in some embodiments the indexing nodes 404 can replace the indexer 206 of one or more architectures of the Parent Applications with all other components of the one or more architectures of the Parent Applications remaining the same. Accordingly, it will be understood that a variety of architectures can be designed using one or more components of the data intake and query system 108 of the present disclosure in combination with one or more components of the data intake and query system 108 of the Parent Applications.
Illustratively, the architecture depicted at FIG. 2 of the Parent Applications may be modified to replace the forwarder 204 of that architecture with the intake system 210 of the present disclosure. In addition, in some cases, the indexers 206 of the Parent Applications can be replaced with the indexing nodes 404 of the present disclosure. In such embodiments, the indexing nodes 404 can retain the buckets in the data stores 412 that they create rather than store the buckets in common storage 216. Further, in the architecture depicted at FIG. 2 of the Parent Applications, the indexing nodes 404 of the present disclosure can be used to execute searches on the buckets stored in the data stores 412. In some embodiments, in the architecture depicted at FIG. 2 of the Parent Applications, the partition manager 408 can receive data from one or more forwarders 204 of the Parent Applications. As additional forwarders 204 are added or as additional data is supplied to the architecture depicted at FIG. 2 of the Parent Applications, the indexing node 406 can spawn additional partition manager 408 and/or the indexing manager system 402 can spawn additional indexing nodes 404. In addition, in certain embodiments, the bucket manager 414 may merge buckets in the data store 414 or be omitted from the architecture depicted at FIG. 2 of the Parent Applications.
Furthermore, in certain embodiments, the search head 210 of the Parent Applications can be replaced with the search head 504 of the present disclosure. In some cases, as described herein, the search head 504 can use the search master 512 and search manager 514 to process and manager the queries. However, rather than communicating with search nodes 506 to execute a query, the search head 504 can, depending on the embodiment, communicate with the indexers 206 of the Parent Applications or the search nodes 404 to execute the query.
Similarly the architecture of FIG. 3 of the Parent Applications may be modified in a variety of ways to include one or more components of the data intake and query system 108 described herein. For example, the architecture of FIG. 3 of the Parent Applications may be modified to include an intake system 210 in accordance with the present disclosure within the cloud-based data intake and query system 1006 of the Parent Applications, which intake system 210 may logically include or communicate with the forwarders 204 of the Parent Applications. In addition, the indexing nodes 404 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement functionality similar to the indexers described with reference to FIG. 3 of the Parent Applications. In addition, the architecture of FIG. 3 of the Parent Applications may be modified to include common storage 216 and/or search nodes 506.
With respect to the architecture of FIG. 4 of the Parent Applications, the intake system 210 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement functionality similar to either or both the forwarders 204 or the ERP processes 410 through 412 of the Parent Applications. Similarly, the indexing nodes 506 and the search head 504 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement functionality similar to the indexer 206 and search head 210, respectively. In some cases, the search manager 514 described herein can manage the communications and interfacing between the indexer 210 and the ERP processes 410 through 412.
With respect to the flow diagrams and functionality described in FIGS. 5A-5C, 6A, 6B, 7A-7D, 8A, 8B, 9, 10, 11A-11D, 12-16, and 17A-17D of the Parent Applications, it will be understood that the processing and indexing operations described as being performed by the indexers 206 can be performed by the indexing nodes 404, the search operations described as being performed by the indexers 206 can be performed by the indexing nodes 404 or search nodes 506 (depending on the embodiment), and/or the searching operations described as being performed by the search head 210, can be performed by the search head 504 or other component of the query system 214.
With reference to FIG. 18 of the Parent Applications, the indexing nodes 404 and search heads 504 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement functionality similar to the indexers 206 and search head 210, respectively. Similarly, the search master 512 and search manager 514 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement functionality similar to the master 212 and the search service provider 216, respectively, described with respect to FIG. 18 of the Parent Applications. Further, the intake system 210 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement ingestion functionality similar to the ingestion functionality of the worker nodes 214 of the Parent Applications. Similarly, the search nodes 506 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement search functionality similar to the search functionality of the worker nodes 214 of the Parent Applications.
With reference to FIG. 25 of the Parent Applications, the indexing nodes 404 and search heads 504 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement functionality similar to the indexers 236 and search heads 226, respectively. In addition, the search head 504 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement functionality similar to the daemon 232 and the master 234 described with respect to FIG. 25 of the Parent Applications. The intake system 210 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement ingestion functionality similar to the ingestion functionality of the worker nodes 214 of the Parent Applications. Similarly, the search nodes 506 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement search functionality similar to the search functionality of the worker nodes 234 of the Parent Applications.
With reference to FIG. 27 of the Parent Applications, the indexing nodes 404 or search nodes 506 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement functionality similar to the index cache components 254. For example, the indexing nodes 404 may be utilized in place of or to implement parsing, indexing, storing functionality of the index cache components 254, and the search nodes 506 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement searching or caching functionality similar to the index cache components 254. In addition, the search head 504 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement functionality similar to the search heads 244, daemon 252, and/or the master 250 described with respect to FIG. 27 of the Parent Applications. The intake system 210 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement ingestion functionality similar to the ingestion functionality of the worker nodes 246 described with respect to FIG. 27 of the Parent Applications. Similarly, the search nodes 506 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement search functionality similar to the search functionality of the worker nodes 234 described with respect to FIG. 27 of the Parent Applications. In addition, the common storage 216 described herein may be utilized in place of or to implement functionality similar to the functionality of the cloud storage 256 and/or global index 258 described with respect to FIG. 27 of the Parent Applications.
As previously mentioned, the intake system 210 can ingest data from a data stream, process the data (e.g., perform various transformations or manipulations of the data), and output the data. For example, the intake system 210 can output the data for storage and use in executing queries. However, the intake system 210 may be limited to ingesting data from a specific set of data streams (e.g., externally defined data streams such as data streams from another system such as Amazon's SQS or Kinesis™ services or a general system defined data stream). For example, each ingestion buffer, as discussed in
To address these issues, embodiments of present disclosure can enable a user to define user defined data streams, which streams may be created and managed by the intake system 108. Each user defined data stream can be populated with data from an intake point or a pipeline. Further, each user defined data stream can be mirrored to a topic on the output buffer or act as an input for a processing pipeline. In order to obviate the need for a system filter, a user may define user defined (e.g., customized) data streams that are each linked to a specific intake point (e.g., data source). Further, the use of user defined data streams can enable data from multiple intake points to be combined. Further, in order to enable daisy chained processing pipelines, a user can define user defined data streams such that a first processing pipeline can obtain data from a data source and write data to an intermediary user defined data stream and a second processing pipeline can obtain data from the intermediary user defined data stream and write data to a data sink. Therefore, the use of user defined data streams can enable a plurality of processing pipelines to be daisy chained together.
Various embodiments of the present disclosure relate to a streaming data processor that enables the custom definition of data streams. A data stream can be a continuous flow of data from a data source or a processing pipeline to a data destination or another processing pipeline. In order to define a user defined data stream, a user and/or a system can define routing criteria (e.g., data boundaries) to manage the data stream. It will be understood that the user defined data stream may be data stream defined by a user, a data stream defined by a system, or any other customized data stream. The routing criteria may define the data that will be written to the data stream and the data that will be read from the data stream. Therefore, based on the defined routing criteria, the source and destination of a particular data stream can be customized and/or defined. For example, a data stream can be populated with a portion of data based on defined routing criteria for the data stream. Further, based on defined routing criteria, the data stream can route data to a data source or a processing pipeline. For example, the routing criteria may define a particular data source that the data stream obtains data from and a particular processing pipeline that the data stream writes data to. These data streams can be defined by a user or can be defined in an automated manner by a system (e.g., a system can define a data stream for a given set of data based on certain observed characteristics). A system can define data streams based on certain observed characteristics of a set of data. For example, a computing system can determine that the set of data includes a large amount of data and, therefore, define a first data stream and populate the first data stream with a first subset of the set of data and define a second data stream and populate the second data stream with a second subset of the set of data. This can enable the computing system to manage the set of data and balance the set of data among multiple data streams. By defining data streams in this manner, the system and/or the user can modify how data is obtained, managed, and used.
The user defined data stream can write data to a processing pipeline. As discussed above, the processing pipeline can perform one or more data transformations on the data. Further, the processing pipeline can write the data to a subsequent user defined data stream. Therefore, the processing pipeline can be a transformation of a first data stream to a second data stream where the first data stream routes data from a source of the data and the second data stream routes transformed data to a destination of the data. Such a use of user defined data streams enables a user to daisy chain multiple processing pipelines together. For example, a first processing pipeline can obtain data and provide the data to a user defined data stream and a second processing pipeline can obtain data via the user defined data stream. By daisy chaining multiple processing pipelines together, the data transformations performed by one processing pipeline can be balanced among multiple processing pipelines. This can increase the speed, efficiency, and/or reliability of the intake system 210. For example, in the event of an anomaly, the loss of data can be mitigated as a particular processing pipeline is only performing a subset of the data transformations. In this manner, data transformations can be linked and/or daisy chained together. Further, data can be looped through a processing pipeline and/or a series of processing pipelines such that the same data transformation or group of data transformations is iteratively performed on the same data.
Therefore, the use of user defined data streams by a streaming data processor enables data partitioning, data sharing, and pipeline chaining. For example, the streaming data processor can separate, both logically and physically, portions of data such that a first subset of the data and a second subset of the data organized and stored separately. Such a logical separation of the data can be based on the type of data, the data source, or any other data characteristics. Further, the use of user defined data streams enables data to be shared between multiple components or parties. For example, a first party may be responsible for and/or manage a first user defined data stream and a second party may be responsible for and/or manage a second user defined data stream, where the same data is routed through the first user defined data stream and the second user defined data stream. Further, the use of user defined data streams enables larger processing pipelines to be separated into smaller processing pipelines that are separated by user defined data streams. For example, a first processing pipeline may be linked to a second processing pipeline via a user defined data stream.
5.1 Data Routes Using User Defined Data Streams and Pipelines
Users may want to define user defined data streams and route data to and from a processing pipeline using the user defined data streams in order to enable data partitioning, data sharing, and pipeline chaining. The techniques described below can enable a user to manage a flow of data through a processing pipeline. The techniques solves challenges of existing data ingestion systems, in that these systems route data to processing pipelines via a general data stream, but the user is unable to customize how the data is streamed to a processing pipeline. This can affect the ability of a user to logically or physically partition data within a processor. This can cause performance and cost issues as the processor routes all data through the same data stream. Further, this can lead to inefficiencies as the data stream cannot be broken into more manageable chunks. Further, this can cause processing pipelines to become unwieldy as a failure in any stage of the processing pipeline can cause the processing pipeline to fail and, as the size of the processing pipeline increases, the processing pipeline can slow down performance of the processor. In the presently disclosed interface, a user can partition data into multiple user defined data streams based on characteristics of the data. Further, the user can break a large pipeline into more manageable chunks with a particular tenant responsible for each chunk. Further, the user can chain multiple pipelines together. The customization process provides viability in how the data streams and the processing pipelines are interacting with data and enables a user to provide user defined data streams and customized processing pipelines.
A streaming data processor may route data via user defined data streams and the customized processing pipelines that are linked together in a data route (e.g., a route of data through one or more user defined data streams and one or more customized processing pipelines). As noted above, such a data route that includes the user defined data streams can enable data partitioning, data sharing, and pipeline chaining as previously discussed. In accordance with aspects of the present disclosure, in order to enable data partitioning, data sharing, and pipeline chaining, the data route may include a user defined data stream that links a first processing pipeline and a second processing pipeline. For example, by linking the first processing pipeline and the second processing pipeline, the transformations performed by a processing pipeline can be balanced among the two processing pipelines.
As discussed above, the streaming data processor 308 and the data route 3400A may be built according to a publish-subscribe (“pub-sub”) message model. In accordance with the pub-sub model, data is ingested into the streaming data processor 308 and the data route 3400A (including the data streams) may be atomized as “messages,” each of which is categorized into one or more “topics.” The data streams can be user or system defined data streams that can be populated by and/or write to a pipeline or an external data source. Each data stream may therefore be a topic on the underlying pub-sub system. The data streams 3402, 3410 can be externally defined data streams and/or general system defined data streams. The data streams 3402, 3410 can be populated with data from a particular source external to the streaming data processor 308 or write data to a particular source external to the streaming data processor 308. For example, the data streams 3402, 3410 may be external streams of data from a streaming data service. For example, the streaming data services can include Amazon's SQS or Kinesis™ services, devices executing Apache Kafka™ software, or devices implementing the MQTT protocol, Microsoft Azure EventHub, Google Cloud Pub Sub, devices implementing the JMS protocol, devices implementing the AMQP), performance metrics, etc. The streaming data services may write data from data storage (e.g., a bucket of data) to a data stream. The streaming data services may implement, manage, and/or configure the routing criteria (e.g., data boundaries) of the data streams 3402, 3410. In some embodiments, one or more of the data streams 3402, 3410 may be a system defined data stream. For example, the system defined data stream may represent a stream from a particular intake point. Therefore, data streams 3402, 3410 can be defined through which the data is routed.
The user defined data stream 3406 is a user defined data stream that enables the processing pipeline 3404 to be linked to the processing pipeline 3408. The user defined data stream 3406 and the data streams 3402, 3410 are each streams of data, however, the user defined data stream 3406 is customizable such that a user and/or a system can define how the user defined data stream 3406 is populated. Whereas, the data streams 3402, 3410 are populated with data from a particular source, the user defined data stream 3406 can be populated with any user defined or system defined set of data. The use of such a user defined data stream 3406 enables two processing pipelines to be connected together. In traditional systems, such a connection of multiple processing pipelines may not be possible as a stream may be connected to a fixed input and a fixed output. By linking the processing pipeline 3404 and the processing pipeline 3408, multiple data transformations can be performed on data received via the data stream 3402. It will be understood that the data route 3400A can include more, less, or different processing pipelines or user defined data streams. For example, the data route 3400A can include three processing pipelines with each processing pipeline separated from a subsequent processing pipeline by a user defined data stream. Further, the data route 3400A can include a loop such that the processing pipeline 3404 obtains a subset of the transformed data from the processing pipeline 3408 via a second user defined data stream. The use of a loop within the data route 3400A can enable the same data transformations to be iteratively performed on a set of data. In some embodiments, a machine learning model, a neural network, etc. can be implemented via the looped pipeline. For example, the machine learning model can iteratively infer and/or reason rules for a given set of data by passing a set of data repeatedly through the looped pipeline. Therefore, the machine learning model can be trained on historical data in order to identify and/or predict subsequently received data. Further, the user defined data stream 3406 can be generated in an automated manner. For example, the user defined data stream 3406 can be updated in a periodic manner in response to observed system characteristics. Further, the user defined data stream 3406 can be updated to account for changes in data traffic or in response to issues/anomalies detected by the streaming data processor 308. In some embodiments, the user and/or the system can populate the user defined data stream 3406 with a given set of data. For example, the user and/or the system can populate the user defined data streams 3414, 3418 with a portion of data from a particular processing pipeline. Therefore, the user defined data stream 3406 enables multiple processing pipelines to be linked in order to perform multiple sets of data transformations in a data route.
The processing pipelines 3404, 3408 can obtain a set of data from a data stream (e.g., a customized data stream, a user defined data stream, a system defined data stream, or an externally defined data stream) and transform the set of data. In order to transform the set of data, the processing pipelines 3404, 3408 can perform one or more data transformations on the set of data. For example, the processing pipelines 3404, 3408 can perform an initial query, an initial segmentation, or any other manipulation of the set of data. The processing pipelines 3404, 3408 can further route the data via another data stream (e.g., a customized data stream, a user defined data stream, a system defined data stream, or an externally defined data stream) The processing pipelines 3404, 3408 can obtain data via a first data stream and route transformed data via a second data stream based on defined routing criteria (e.g., a source, a destination, and data transformations) for the corresponding processing pipeline. For example, a user can, by defining the routing criteria, define a processing pipeline as reading data from a particular data stream and routing data to a particular data stream. Further, the processing pipelines 3404, 3408 can perform the one or more data transformations based on the routing criteria. For example, the user can define the transformations that the processing pipelines 3404, 3408 perform. Therefore, the processing pipelines 3404, 3408 can perform data transformations on received data.
The user defined data stream 3406 can be a flow (e.g., a path) of data from a data source or a processing pipeline to another data source or a processing pipeline. For example, the user defined data stream 3406 can be a flow of data from a first processing pipeline to a second processing pipeline. The user defined data stream 3406 can be defined based on routing criteria and implemented by the streaming data processor 308. For example, the routing criteria may indicate how the data is to be routed via the user defined data stream (e.g., from a particular source to a particular destination). The routing criteria can further define how a user defined data stream 3406 performs in routing data.
The user defined data stream 3406 may also be associated with stream characteristics, stream policies, and/or a stream schema. The stream characteristics may indicate current characteristics of how the user defined data stream is performing. For example, the stream characteristics can include a timestamp characteristic, a source characteristic, a nanosecond characteristic, a body characteristic, a set of attributes characteristic, a source type characteristic, a kind characteristic, a stream name characteristic, an identification characteristic, a host characteristic, or any other stream characteristics. Each stream characteristics may be associated with a corresponding value indicating how the user defined data stream 3406 is performing. For example, the host characteristic may indicate a current host of the user defined data stream 3406 (e.g., Server X) and the source characteristic may indicate a source of the user defined data stream 3406 (e.g., Processing Pipeline Y). It will be understood that the stream characteristics can include any characteristics that illustrate how the user defined data stream is routing data. In some embodiments, the user defined data stream 3406 may be associated with a stream schema that defines the particular characteristics that are to be reported as stream characteristics. For example, the stream schema may indicate that a body characteristic and a timestamp characteristic are the stream characteristics for a given user defined data stream 3406. The stream policies may define how the user defined data stream 3406 routes the data and retains the data. For example, the stream policies can include a storage quota, a data retention policy, a throughput, or any other stream policies. Therefore, the user defined data stream 3406 can be associated with stream characteristics, stream policies, and/or a stream schema.
A streaming data processor 308 implementing the data route 3400A can obtain (e.g., read) data from a data stream 3402. In order to read the data from the data stream 3402, the user and/or the system can define a processing pipeline 3404 that obtains data from a data stream 3402. For example, the user may define the processing pipeline 3404 to read the data from Amazon's Kinesis™ service. The user and/or the system can define what data is read from Amazon's Kinesis™ service based on defined routing criteria. For example, the user can define a processing pipeline that obtains data based on the routing criteria. The user and/or the system can further define one or more data transformations that the processing pipeline 3404 performs. For example, the user can define a data manipulation that the processing pipeline 3404 performs on data received at the processing pipeline 3404. Based on the one or more data transformations, the processing pipeline 3404 can generate transformed data. The user and/or the system can further define the processing pipeline 3404 as writing transformed data to the user defined data stream 3406. Based on this definition, the processing pipeline writes the transformed data to the user defined data stream 3406. Therefore, the processing pipeline 3404 can perform data transformations and write the transformed data to the user defined data stream 3406.
The user defined data stream 3406 can flow (e.g., route) data from the processing pipeline 3404 to the processing pipeline 3408. The user can define the user defined data stream 3406 as a destination of the processing pipeline 3404 and a source of the processing pipeline 3408. In order to determine how the data is routed by the user defined data stream 3406, a user and/or system can define routing criteria for the user defined data stream 3406 that indicates the processing pipeline 3404 as a source of the user defined data stream 3406 and the processing pipeline 3408 as a destination of the user defined data stream 3408. The user and/or the system can further define stream policies for the user defined data stream 3406. The user defined data stream 3406 may be associated with a stream schema and stream characteristics. Therefore, based on the routing criteria, the user defined data stream 3406 routes the transformed data from the processing pipeline 3404 to the processing pipeline 3408.
The processing pipeline 3408 can obtain the transformed data from the processing pipeline 3404 via the user defined data stream 3406. In order to read the data from the user defined data stream 3406, the user and/or the system can define a processing pipeline 3408 that obtains the transformed data from the user defined data stream 3406. The user and/or the system can further define additional data transformations that the processing pipeline 3408 performs. In some embodiments, the processing pipeline 3404 and the processing pipeline 3408 can perform different data transformations. In other embodiments, the processing pipeline 3404 and the processing pipeline 3408 can perform the same data transformations. Based on the additional data transformations, the processing pipeline 3408 can manipulate the transformed data from the processing pipeline 3404 to generate further transformed data. The user and/or the system can further define the processing pipeline 3408 as writing the further transformed data to a data stream 3410. Based on this definition, the processing pipeline 3408 writes the further transformed data to the data stream 3410. For example, the streaming data processor 308 can write the further transformed data to Amazon's Kinesis™ service. Therefore, the processing pipeline 3408 can perform additional data transformations and write the transformed data to the data stream 3410.
As noted above, a data route may include a user defined data stream that routes data between processing pipelines to enable data partitioning, data sharing, and pipeline chaining as previously discussed. In accordance with aspects of the present disclosure, in order to enable data portioning, data sharing, and pipeline chaining, the data route may also include user defined data streams that route data to a data sink from a processing pipeline or from a data source to a processing pipeline. For example, by linking a data source or data sink to a processing pipeline via the user defined data stream, the data being routed through the data route can be partitioned.
The data source 3412 can be a source of data that is read into a streaming data processor 308. The data source 3412 can initiate the data route 3400B through the streaming data processor 308. The data source 3412 can be a bucket of data managed by a bucket storage service (e.g., a bucket of data stored and managed by EBS), an object managed by an object storage service, a data stream, or any other source of data. Further, the data source 3412 can be a batch source or a streaming source. A batch source can provide data to the streaming data processor 308 at rest (e.g., a batch source can be an object stored in S3 that provides data at rest) and a streaming source can provide data to the streaming data processor 308 in motion (e.g., a streaming source can be a data stream stored in Kinesis that provides data in motion). Examples of data sources 3412 include, without limitation, data files, directories of files, data sent over a network, event logs, registries, performance metrics, etc. The data source 3412 can write the data to a user defined data stream. In some embodiments, the data source 3412 can write the data to multiple user defined data streams. Therefore, the data source 3412 can be an origination of data read into the data route 3400B.
The user defined data streams 3414, 3418 can obtain data from a data source or a processing pipeline and write data to a data sink or a processing pipeline. The user defined data streams 3414, 3418 can be defined or customized to obtain data from a particular data source or a processing pipeline and write data to a particular data sink or a processing pipeline. Therefore, the user defined data streams 3414, 3418 enable a user to provide custom definitions of a stream of data.
As previously discussed with reference to
The data sink 3420 can be a data endpoint, a data store, a data reservoir, etc. The data sink 3420 can receive data and terminate the data route 3400B through the streaming data processor 308. The data sink 3420 can be a bucket of data managed by a bucket storage service (e.g., a bucket of data stored and managed by EBS), an object managed by an object storage service, a data stream, or any other sink that data can be written to. Examples of data sinks 3420 include, without limitation, data files, directories of files, data sent over a network, event logs, registries, performance metrics, etc. In some embodiments, the data sink 3420 can act as a data sink for a first data route and a data source for a second data route thereby allowing the streaming data processor 308 to loop multiple processing pipelines within a data route. Therefore, the data sink 3420 can be an endpoint for the data route 3400B.
A streaming data processor 308 implementing the data route 3400B can obtain (e.g., read) data from the data source 3412. In order to read the data from the data source 3412, the user and/or the system can define a user defined data stream 3414 that is populated with data from the data source 3412. For example, the user and/or the system can define the user defined data stream 3414 with particular routing criteria such that the user defined data stream 3414 is populated with data from the data source. Based on the defined routing criteria, the user defined data stream 3414 can route data from the data source 3412 into the data route 3400B. For example, the user may define the user defined data stream 3414 such that the user defined data stream 3414 is populated with data from an object stored in Amazon's S3 service. In some embodiments, the user and/or the system can define the user defined data stream 3414 such that the user defined data stream routes a portion of the data produced by the data source 3412 into the data route 3400B. For example, the user may define the user defined data stream 3414 such that the user defined data stream 3414 is periodically populated with data from the data source 3412 (e.g., every second, every three seconds, etc.). Further, the user can define the user defined data stream 3414 such that the user defined data stream 3414 is populated with data from the data source 3412 based on the occurrence of a particular event. For example, when a particular subset of data (e.g., data indicating an anomalous event), the user defined data stream 3414 can be populated with the corresponding data. The user and/or the system can further define the user defined data stream 3414 to customize how the user defined data streams 3414 routes the data. For example, the user and/or the system can define a stream schema, stream characteristics, and/or stream policies. Therefore, the user defined data stream 3414 can route data between the data source 3412 and the processing pipeline.
The processing pipeline 3416 can obtain data from the data source 3412 via the user defined data stream 3414. Based on the customized definitions of the user defined data stream 3414 and the processing pipeline 3416, the user defined data stream 3414 acts as a link to route data between the data source 3412 and the processing pipeline 3416. The user and/or the system can further define data transformations to be performed by the processing pipeline 3416. For example, the user can define manipulations (e.g., segmentations, enrichment, etc.) that are to be performed on the data to generate transformed data. The user and/or the system can further define the processing pipeline 3416 such that the processing pipeline 3416 writes the transformed data to the user defined data stream 3418. Therefore, the processing pipeline can be defined to obtain data from the user defined data stream 3414, transform the data based on defined data transformations, and route the transformed data to the user defined data stream 3418.
Based on the defined processing pipeline 3416, the user defined data stream 3418 can be populated with the transformed data. The user and/or the system can define user defined data stream 3418 in order to customize how the user defined data stream 3418 routes data. In order to define the user defined data stream 3418, the user and/or the system, can further define routing criteria. Based on the defined routing criteria, the user defined data stream 3418 can route data from the processing pipeline 3416 to the data sink 3420. Therefore, the user defined data stream 3418 can be a link from the processing pipeline 3416 to the data sink 3420 in order to route data out of the data route 3400B. For example, the user may define the user defined data stream 3418 such that the user defined data stream 3418 populates an object stored in Amazon's S3 service with the transformed data. In some embodiments, the user and/or the system can define the user defined data stream 3418 such that the user defined data stream 3418 routes a portion of the data transformed by the processing pipeline 3416 into the data sink. For example, the user may route a first portion of the transformed data to the data sink 3420 via a first user defined data stream and a second portion of the transformed data to a processing pipeline (e.g., the processing pipeline 3416 or a different processing pipeline). Therefore, the data route 3400B can route the data from the data source 3412 to the data sink 3420 via the user defined data streams 3414, 3418 and the processing pipeline 3416 such that data transformations are performed on the data prior to the transformed data being stored in the data sink 3420.
As discussed above, a streaming data processor may route data via user defined data streams and the customized processing pipelines that are linked together in a data route. By including a user defined data stream in the data route, multiple processing pipelines can be linked together. Linking the processing pipeline enables modularity of the data route as the first processing pipeline can perform a first portion of the data transformations for the data route and the second processing pipeline can perform a second portion of the data transformations for the data route. Further, such a modularity can be beneficial where one of the processing pipelines performs common operations and multiple processing pipelines can be linked to the processing pipeline performing the common operation. For example, a first processing pipeline and a second processing pipeline can route data via corresponding user defined data streams to a third processing pipeline that is performing a common data transformation. With reference to
In order to implement a data route based on the first input and the second input that includes the user defined data stream and the first and second processing pipelines, at block 3504, the streaming data processor 308 receives a set of data at the first externally defined data stream. The streaming data processor 308 can receive the set of data to be passed through the data route such that the set of data is iteratively transformed. The first externally defined data stream can read the set of data into the streaming data processor 308 from an external data service such as S3. The streaming data processor 308 can define the set of data received from the first externally defined data stream as corresponding to a data route 3400A. In some embodiments, the streaming data processor 308 can obtain data from a plurality of externally defined data streams. Therefore, the streaming data processor 308 can receive the set of data from the first externally defined data stream for the data route 3400A.
Based at least in part on the first input, in order to perform a first modular set of data transformations, at block 3506, the streaming data processor 308 performs one or more first data transformations on the set of data to generate a first set of transformed data. The streaming data processor 308 can perform the one or more first data transformations using the first processing pipeline. The first user input can define the first processing pipeline as obtaining data from the first externally defined data stream. The first user input can further define the first processing pipeline as performing the one or more first data transformations on the set of data. Based on the one or more first data transformations, the first processing pipeline can generate a first set of transformed data. Therefore, based on the first user input, the streaming data processor 308 performs one or more first data transformations to generate a first set of transformed data.
In order to route data between the first processing pipeline and the second processing pipeline and enable the modularity of the processing pipelines, at block 3508, the streaming data processor 308 populates the user defined data stream with the first set of transformed data based on the routing criteria and the first user input. The user can define, by the first user input, the destination of the processing pipeline as the user defined data stream. Therefore, based on the first user input, the streaming data processor 308 can populate the user defined data stream with the first set of transformed data.
Based at least in part on the routing criteria and the first user input, in order to perform a second modular set of transformations, at block 3510, the streaming data processor 308 performs one or more second data transformations on the first set of transformed data to generate a second set of transformed data. The first user input can perform the one or more second data transformations using the second processing pipeline. The first user input can define the second processing pipeline as obtaining data from the user defined data stream. The first user input can further define the second processing pipeline as performing the one or more second data transformations on the first set of transformed data. Based on the one or more second data transformations, the second processing pipeline can generate a second set of transformed data. In some embodiments, the second set of transformed data may be routed to a third processing pipeline via a second user defined data stream. For example, the data may be routed through any number of processing pipelines and user defined data streams. In some embodiments, a subsequent set of data may be received by the streaming data processor 308 from a third externally defined data stream. The streaming data processor 308 can route the subsequent set of data through a third processing pipeline, a second user defined data stream, and a fourth processing pipeline based on user input. Subsequent sets of data may correspond to different data transformations based on the user input. Therefore, based on the first user input, the streaming data processor 308 performs one or more second data transformations to generate a second set of transformed data.
In order to output the second set of transformed data after the performance of the modular transformations, at block 3512, based on the first user input, the streaming data processor 308 routes the second set of transformed data to a second externally defined data stream. The first user input can define the second externally defined data stream as the destination of the second processing pipeline. In some embodiments, the streaming data processor 308 can write data to a plurality of externally defined data streams. Therefore, the streaming data processor 308 can route the data from the second processing pipeline to the second externally defined data stream.
As discussed above, a streaming data processor may route data via user defined data streams and the customized processing pipelines that are linked together in a data route. By including a user defined data stream in the data route, the external data source and the external data sink that the processing pipeline obtains data from and writes data to can be modified. Obtaining data from and writing data to user defined data streams enables flexibility of the streaming data processor by enabling a user to have the flexibility to choose a stream that data is written to. The flexibility of the streaming data processor enables the streaming data processor to avoid aggregating disparate data with different processing requirements into the same stream. For example, a first user defined data stream can obtain data from a set of sensors and a second user defined data stream can obtain data from a set of application logs. With reference to
In order to implement a data route based at least in part on the first user input and the second user input, at block 3604, the streaming data processor 308 receives a set of data. The streaming data processor 308 can receive the set of data from a data source such as a block storage service. The data source may be a batch source or a streaming source. Therefore, the streaming data processor 308 can receive the set of data from a data source for the data route 3400B.
Based at least in part on the routing criteria, in order to route a set of data via the first user defined data stream, where additional data can be routed by different data streams, at block 3606, the streaming data processor 308 populates the first user defined data stream of the set of user defined data streams with a subset of the set of data. The routing criteria can indicate that the subset of the set of data that populates the first user defined data stream. Based on the routing criteria, the streaming data processor 308 can route the subset of the set of data via the user defined data stream. In some embodiments, the streaming data processor 308 can populate the first user defined data stream with the entire set of data. Therefore, the streaming data processor 308 populates the first user defined data stream with a subset of the set of data. Further, based on the second user input, the streaming data processor 308 can route the subset of the set of data to the processing pipeline via the first user defined data stream. The second user input can define the first user defined data stream as the source of the processing pipeline, the one or more data transformations of the processing pipeline, and the second user defined data stream as the destination of the processing pipeline. In some embodiments, the processing pipeline can obtain data from a plurality of user defined data streams. Therefore, the streaming data processor 308 populates the first user defined data stream with the subset of the set of data and routes the subset of the set of data from the data source to the processing pipeline via the first user defined data stream.
In order to perform a set of data transformations particular to the set of data received by the first user defined data stream and thereby allowing the processing pipeline to perform transformations specific to a set of data, at block 3608, based on the second user input, the streaming data processor 308 performs one or more data transformations on the subset of the set of data to generate a set of transformed data. The streaming data processor 308, based on the second user input and the routing criteria, can route the subset of the set of data from the data source to the processing pipeline via the first user defined data stream. Based on receiving the subset of the set of data at the processing pipeline, the streaming data processor 308 can perform one or more data transformations on the subset of the set of data. The second user input may define the one or more data transformations to be performed by the streaming data processor 308 via the processing pipeline. The streaming data processor 308 can transform the subset of the set of data using the one or more data transformations to generate the set of transformed data. Therefore, the streaming data processor 308 can perform the one or more data transformations, based on the second user input, on the subset of the set of data to generate a set of transformed data.
In order to route data to a specific data source associated with the data route, based at least in part on the second user input, at block 3610, the streaming data processor 308 populates a second user defined data stream of the set of user defined data streams with the set of transformed data. The second user input can indicate that the set of transformed data populates the second user defined data stream. Based on the second user input, the streaming data processor 308 can route the set of transformed data via the second user defined data stream. Therefore, the streaming data processor 308 populates the second user defined data stream with the set of transformed data. Further, based on the routing criteria, the streaming data processor 308 can route the set of transformed data from the processing pipeline to a data sink via the second user defined data stream. In some embodiments, the processing pipeline can write data to a plurality of user defined data streams. The routing criteria can define the data sink as a destination of the second user defined data stream. In some embodiments, the streaming data processor 308 can obtain a third input defining an additional processing pipeline and route a second set of data from a data source to a second processing pipeline via a third user defined data stream and from the second processing pipeline to a data sink via a fourth user defined data stream. Therefore, the streaming data processor 308 populates the second user defined data stream with the set of transformed data and routes the set of transformed data from the processing pipeline to the data sink via the second user defined data stream.
5.2 Graphical Controls for Defining and Implementing Data Streams
A system can be provided to enable the creation of user defined data streams and processing pipelines that can be linked to the user defined data streams. The system can enable the creation of the user defined data streams and processing pipelines based on received user input that identify routing criteria. Based on the received user input, a data route that includes the user defined data streams and the processing pipelines can be implemented. The received user input may be received through any method of receiving user input. For example, as described in
As discussed above, a streaming data processor may route data via user defined data streams. By including a user defined data stream in the data route, multiple processing pipelines can be linked together enabling modularity of the data route. By interacting with a GUI, a user can define the user defined data stream to define how the user defined data streams handles data. Further, the user can identify data that should populate the user defined data stream. Identifying the data that should populate the user defined data stream can be beneficial as the user can partition a subset of data into a particular user defined data stream without requiring the use of a filter. For example, a first user defined data stream can be populated with particular data and a second user defined data stream can be populated with different data.
Via the interface 3700, the user can define the stream based on elements provided in the interface. In some embodiments, the user can define the stream based on stream policies that indicate how the user defined data stream routes data. The streaming data processor 308 may use the stream policies in order to generate the user defined data stream.
In some embodiments, the interface 3700 can identify multiple data streams for a particular streaming data processor 308. For example, the interface 3700 can identify multiple data streams within a data route. In some embodiments, the interface 3700 can identify one or more data streams of a first data route and one or more data streams of a second data route where each data route is associated with the streaming data processor 308. The data streams shown and/or identified by the interface 3700 can be based on data streams selected by a user. For example, a user can select a particular data stream for modification via an interaction with the interface 3700.
The client interface 3700 may include a data stream identifier 3702. The data stream identifier 3702 may identify a particular data stream and provide information about the particular data stream. The user may toggle between various data streams using the data stream identifier 3702. For example, the user can toggle between multiple data streams corresponding to the same data route. The data stream identifier 3702 may correspond to any numerical, alphabetical, alphanumerical, or symbolical string. For example, the data stream identifier 3702 may correspond to the order of generation of the corresponding data stream. The data stream identifier 3702 may identify a data stream and corresponding characteristics, policies, or schemas of the data stream may be identified within the interface 3700. For example, a data stream implemented by the streaming data processor 308 may correspond to “Stream X.”
The interface 3700 may further include a first page 3704A, a second page 3704B, a third page 3704C, and a fourth page 3704D. The interface 3700 may include a home page 3704A. The home page 3704A may, based on an interaction between a user and the home page 3704A, illustrate a home page 3704A for a data route corresponding to the data stream. Further, the home page 3704A may correspond to a number of selectable data streams. For example, the home page 3704A may illustrate a number of data streams within the data route. As will be further discussed, the home page 3704A may further include a plurality of selectable elements that the user can interact with to further customize the data route and define how data is routed by the streaming data processor 308. The interface 3700 may further include a stream page 3704B. The stream page 3704B identifies a particular data stream and one or more user configurable settings and/or elements for the particular data stream. The user can interact with the one or more user configurable settings and/or elements with to modify the data stream. For example, the settings of the stream page 3704B can correspond to stream policies or a stream schema that are selectable and customizable by a user. The interface 3700 may further include a data management page 3704C identifying how data is managed within the data route. For example, the data management page 3704C can identify how the data is read from an externally defined data stream, a system defined data stream, or a data source and/or identify how data is stored in an externally defined data stream, a system defined data stream, or a data sink. The interface 3700 may further include a user management page 3704D identifying the user. The user can interact with the user management page 3704D to customize the role of the user, permissions associated with the user, or other customizable features associated with the user.
The stream page 3704B of the interface 3700 can further include various elements within the stream page 3704B. The stream page 3704B can include a stream schema element 3706, a stream characteristics element 3708, a stream population element 3710, and a stream policies element 3712. The stream schema element 3706 can illustrate a current stream schema associated with the data stream. In the example of
The stream page 3704B can further include a stream characteristics element 3708. The stream characteristics element 3708 can illustrate current stream characteristics associated with a data stream. The stream characteristics can define statistics indicating how data is routed by the data stream. For example, the stream characteristics can include a timestamp characteristic, a source characteristic, a nanosecond characteristic, a body characteristic, a set of attributes characteristic, a source type characteristic, a kind characteristic, a stream name characteristic, an identification characteristic, and/or a host characteristic. It will be understood that the stream characteristics element 3708 may identify more, less, or different stream characteristics. The stream characteristics element 3708 can identify a current value for each stream characteristics. In the example of
In some embodiments, the stream page 3704B can further include a stream population element 3710. The stream population element 3710 can enable a user to define routing criteria (e.g., a set of data that populates the data stream). For example, via the stream population element 3710, the user can modify the data stream such that the data stream is populated with data from a particular data source. In some embodiments, the stream page 3704B may not include the stream population element 3710. In other embodiments, the stream page 3704B may include the stream population element 3710 and the user may not elect to populate the data stream with a particular set of data. For example, while the user may not populate the data stream with a given set of data, as will be discussed, the user may populate the data stream by defining a processing pipeline that obtains data via the data stream. In some embodiments, the stream population element 3710 may include an element to search for a particular set of data to populate the particular data stream. Therefore, the stream page 3704B can include a stream population element that enables a user to define a set of data that will populate the data stream.
The stream page 3704B can further include a stream policies element 3712. The stream policies element 3712 can illustrate current stream policies associated with a data stream. The stream policies can define how the data stream is configured. For example, the stream policies can include a storage quota, a data retention policy, or a throughput for the data stream. It will be understood that the stream policies element 3712 may identify more, less, or different stream policies. The stream policies element 3712 can identify a current value for each stream policy. In the example of
As discussed above, a streaming data processor may route data via user defined data streams that links processing pipelines. By including a user defined data stream in the data route, multiple processing pipelines can be modified to route data to and from the user defined data stream. By interacting with a GUI, a user can define the processing pipeline to define how the processing pipeline routes data to and from a user defined data stream. Linking a user defined data stream to a processing pipeline can be beneficial as the user can link specific user defined data streams to the processing pipeline without requiring the use of a filter. For example, a first user defined data stream can write data to a first processing pipeline and a second user defined data stream can write data to a second processing pipeline.
Via the interface 3800, the user can define the pipeline based on elements provided in the interface. In some embodiments, the user can define the pipeline based on custom elements. For example, the user can define how the processing pipeline obtains data and writes transformed data. The streaming data processor 308 may use the pipeline definition to generate the processing pipeline. For example, the pipeline definition can include a source, a destination, and one or more data transformations for the processing pipeline.
In some embodiments, the interface 3800 can identify multiple processing pipelines for a particular streaming data processor 308. For example, the interface 3800 can identify multiple processing pipelines within a data route. In some embodiments, the interface 3800 can identify one or more processing pipelines of a first data route and one or more processing pipelines of a second data route where each data route is associated with the streaming data processor 308. The data streams shown and/or identified by the interface 3800 can be based on processing pipelines selected by a user. For example, a user can select a particular processing pipeline for modification via an interaction with the interface 3800.
The client interface 3800 may include a processing pipeline identifier 3802. The processing pipeline identifier 3802 may identify a particular processing pipeline and provide information about the particular processing pipeline. The user may toggle between various processing pipelines using the processing pipeline identifier 3802. For example, the user can toggle between multiple processing pipelines corresponding to the same data route. The processing pipeline identifier 3802 may correspond to any numerical, alphabetical, alphanumerical, or symbolical string. For example, the processing pipeline identifier 3802 may correspond to the order of generation of the corresponding processing pipeline. The processing pipeline identifier 3802 may identify a processing pipeline and corresponding characteristics of the processing pipeline may be identified within the interface 3800. For example, a processing pipeline implemented by the streaming data processor 308 may correspond to “Pipeline X.”
The interface 3800 may further include a first page 3804A, a second page 3804B, a third page 3804C, and a fourth page 3804D. The interface 3800 may include a home page 3804A. The home page 3804A may, based on an interaction between a user and the home page 3804A, illustrate a home page 3804A for a data route corresponding to the processing pipeline. Further, the home page 3804A may correspond to a number of selectable processing pipelines. The interface 3800 may further include a pipeline page 3804B. The pipeline page 3804B identifies a particular processing pipeline and one or more user configurable characteristics for the particular processing pipeline. The user can interact with the one or more user configurable settings and/or elements with to modify the processing pipeline. The interface 3800 may further include a data management page 3804C identifying how data is managed within the data route. For example, the data management page 3804C can identify how the data is read from an externally defined data stream, a system defined data stream, or data source and/or identify how data is stored in an externally defined data stream, a system defined data stream, or data sink. The interface 3800 may further include a user management page 3804D identifying the user. The user can interact with the user management page 3804D to customize the role of the user, permissions associated with the user, or other customizable features associated with the user.
The pipeline page 3804B of the interface 3800 can further include various elements within the pipeline page 3804B to identify the routing criteria. The pipeline page 3804B can include a source element 3806, a destination element 3808, and a data transformations element 3810 that each identify routing criteria for the processing pipeline. The source element 3806 can identify a current source of the processing pipeline. In the example of
The pipeline page 3804B of the interface 3800 can further include a destination element 3808. The destination element 3808 can identify a current destination of the processing pipeline. In the example of
The stream page 3804B can further include a data transformations element 3810. The data transformations element 3810 can illustrate data transformations that are being performed by Pipeline X. The data transformations element 3810 can further enable the user to modify the data transformations that are being performed by Pipeline X. The user can upload new data transformations, update the current data transformations, or otherwise manipulate the data transformations. In the example of
As discussed above, a streaming data processor may route data via user defined data streams that link processing pipelines. By interacting with a GUI, a user can define the user defined data streams and the processing pipelines to define how the user defined data streams link the processing pipelines. Further, the user can identify data that should populate the user defined data streams and be routed through the user defined data streams and the processing pipelines. The user can further identify routing criteria in order to manage the subset of data that is transmitted through each user defined data stream. For example, a first user defined data stream linked to a first processing pipeline can be populated with particular data and a second user defined data stream linked to a second processing pipeline can be populated with different data. With reference to
In order to define processing pipelines that write data and read data from user defined data streams, at block 3904, the streaming data processor 308 causes display of second graphical controls that enable the user to define processing pipelines that each obtain data from a particular user defined data stream and write transformed data to a particular user defined data stream. The second graphical controls can enable a user to define a source, a destination, and/or data transformations for the processing pipeline as described previously with respect to
Based at least in part on the input received via the first graphical controls and the second graphical controls, at block 3906, the streaming data processor 308 implements the user defined data streams and the processing pipelines. The streaming data processor 308 can implement the user defined data streams and the processing pipelines based on the custom definitions provided by the user via the first graphical controls and the second graphical controls. In some embodiments, a pub-sub message model associated with the streaming data processor 308 can implement the user defined data streams and the processing pipelines.
In order to implement the data route, at block 3908, the streaming data processor 308 routes a set of data via the user defined data streams and the processing pipelines. The streaming data processor 308 may route a set of data from a data source, an externally defined data stream, or a system defined data stream through the user defined data streams and the processing pipelines to a data sink, an externally defined data stream, or a system defined data stream.
Computer programs typically comprise one or more instructions set at various times in various memory devices of a computing device, which, when read and executed by at least one processor, will cause a computing device to execute functions involving the disclosed techniques. In some embodiments, a carrier containing the aforementioned computer program product is provided. The carrier is one of an electronic signal, an optical signal, a radio signal, or a non-transitory computer-readable storage medium.
Any or all of the features and functions described above can be combined with each other, except to the extent it may be otherwise stated above or to the extent that any such embodiments may be incompatible by virtue of their function or structure, as will be apparent to persons of ordinary skill in the art. Unless contrary to physical possibility, it is envisioned that (i) the methods/steps described herein may be performed in any sequence and/or in any combination, and (ii) the components of respective embodiments may be combined in any manner.
Although the subject matter has been described in language specific to structural features and/or acts, it is to be understood that the subject matter defined in the appended claims is not necessarily limited to the specific features or acts described above. Rather, the specific features and acts described above are disclosed as examples of implementing the claims, and other equivalent features and acts are intended to be within the scope of the claims.
Conditional language, such as, among others, “can,” “could,” “might,” or “may,” unless specifically stated otherwise, or otherwise understood within the context as used, is generally intended to convey that certain embodiments include, while other embodiments do not include, certain features, elements and/or steps. Thus, such conditional language is not generally intended to imply that features, elements and/or steps are in any way required for one or more embodiments or that one or more embodiments necessarily include logic for deciding, with or without user input or prompting, whether these features, elements and/or steps are included or are to be performed in any particular embodiment.
Unless the context clearly requires otherwise, throughout the description and the claims, the words “comprise,” “comprising,” and the like are to be construed in an inclusive sense, as opposed to an exclusive or exhaustive sense, i.e., in the sense of “including, but not limited to.” As used herein, the terms “connected,” “coupled,” or any variant thereof means any connection or coupling, either direct or indirect, between two or more elements; the coupling or connection between the elements can be physical, logical, or a combination thereof. Additionally, the words “herein,” “above,” “below,” and words of similar import, when used in this application, refer to this application as a whole and not to any particular portions of this application. Where the context permits, words using the singular or plural number may also include the plural or singular number respectively. The word “or” in reference to a list of two or more items, covers all of the following interpretations of the word: any one of the items in the list, all of the items in the list, and any combination of the items in the list. Likewise the term “and/or” in reference to a list of two or more items, covers all of the following interpretations of the word: any one of the items in the list, all of the items in the list, and any combination of the items in the list.
Conjunctive language such as the phrase “at least one of X, Y and Z,” unless specifically stated otherwise, is otherwise understood with the context as used in general to convey that an item, term, etc. may be either X, Y or Z, or any combination thereof. Thus, such conjunctive language is not generally intended to imply that certain embodiments require at least one of X, at least one of Y and at least one of Z to each be present. Further, use of the phrase “at least one of X, Y or Z” as used in general is to convey that an item, term, etc. may be either X, Y or Z, or any combination thereof.
In some embodiments, certain operations, acts, events, or functions of any of the algorithms described herein can be performed in a different sequence, can be added, merged, or left out altogether (e.g., not all are necessary for the practice of the algorithms). In certain embodiments, operations, acts, functions, or events can be performed concurrently, e.g., through multi-threaded processing, interrupt processing, or multiple processors or processor cores or on other parallel architectures, rather than sequentially.
Systems and modules described herein may comprise software, firmware, hardware, or any combination(s) of software, firmware, or hardware suitable for the purposes described. Software and other modules may reside and execute on servers, workstations, personal computers, computerized tablets, PDAs, and other computing devices suitable for the purposes described herein. Software and other modules may be accessible via local computer memory, via a network, via a browser, or via other means suitable for the purposes described herein. Data structures described herein may comprise computer files, variables, programming arrays, programming structures, or any electronic information storage schemes or methods, or any combinations thereof, suitable for the purposes described herein. User interface elements described herein may comprise elements from graphical user interfaces, interactive voice response, command line interfaces, and other suitable interfaces.
Further, processing of the various components of the illustrated systems can be distributed across multiple machines, networks, and other computing resources. Two or more components of a system can be combined into fewer components. Various components of the illustrated systems can be implemented in one or more virtual machines or an isolated execution environment, rather than in dedicated computer hardware systems and/or computing devices. Likewise, the data repositories shown can represent physical and/or logical data storage, including, e.g., storage area networks or other distributed storage systems. Moreover, in some embodiments the connections between the components shown represent possible paths of data flow, rather than actual connections between hardware. While some examples of possible connections are shown, any of the subset of the components shown can communicate with any other subset of components in various implementations.
Embodiments are also described above with reference to flow chart illustrations and/or block diagrams of methods, apparatus (systems) and computer program products. Each block of the flow chart illustrations and/or block diagrams, and combinations of blocks in the flow chart illustrations and/or block diagrams, may be implemented by computer program instructions. Such instructions may be provided to a processor of a general purpose computer, special purpose computer, specially-equipped computer (e.g., comprising a high-performance database server, a graphics subsystem, etc.) or other programmable data processing apparatus to produce a machine, such that the instructions, which execute via the processor(s) of the computer or other programmable data processing apparatus, create means for implementing the acts specified in the flow chart and/or block diagram block or blocks. These computer program instructions may also be stored in a non-transitory computer-readable memory that can direct a computer or other programmable data processing apparatus to operate in a particular manner, such that the instructions stored in the computer-readable memory produce an article of manufacture including instruction means which implement the acts specified in the flow chart and/or block diagram block or blocks. The computer program instructions may also be loaded to a computing device or other programmable data processing apparatus to cause operations to be performed on the computing device or other programmable apparatus to produce a computer implemented process such that the instructions which execute on the computing device or other programmable apparatus provide steps for implementing the acts specified in the flow chart and/or block diagram block or blocks.
Any patents and applications and other references noted above, including any that may be listed in accompanying filing papers, are incorporated herein by reference. Aspects of the invention can be modified, if necessary, to employ the systems, functions, and concepts of the various references described above to provide yet further implementations of the invention. These and other changes can be made to the invention in light of the above Detailed Description. While the above description describes certain examples of the invention, and describes the best mode contemplated, no matter how detailed the above appears in text, the invention can be practiced in many ways. Details of the system may vary considerably in its specific implementation, while still being encompassed by the invention disclosed herein. As noted above, particular terminology used when describing certain features or aspects of the invention should not be taken to imply that the terminology is being redefined herein to be restricted to any specific characteristics, features, or aspects of the invention with which that terminology is associated. In general, the terms used in the following claims should not be construed to limit the invention to the specific examples disclosed in the specification, unless the above Detailed Description section explicitly defines such terms. Accordingly, the actual scope of the invention encompasses not only the disclosed examples, but also all equivalent ways of practicing or implementing the invention under the claims.
To reduce the number of claims, certain aspects of the invention are presented below in certain claim forms, but the applicant contemplates other aspects of the invention in any number of claim forms. For example, while only one aspect of the invention is recited as a means-plus-function claim under 35 U.S.C. sec. 112(f) (AIA), other aspects may likewise be embodied as a means-plus-function claim, or in other forms, such as being embodied in a computer-readable medium. Any claims intended to be treated under 35 U.S.C. § 112(f) will begin with the words “means for,” but use of the term “for” in any other context is not intended to invoke treatment under 35 U.S.C. § 112(f). Accordingly, the applicant reserves the right to pursue additional claims after filing this application, in either this application or in a continuing application.
Various example embodiments of methods, systems, and non-transitory computer-readable media relating to features described herein can be found in the following clauses:
Clause 1. A method, comprising:
obtaining, by a streaming data processing system, a first input defining a set of data streams and a set of stream schemas, wherein each stream schema of the set of stream schemas defines how a corresponding data stream routes data, wherein a first data stream of the set of data streams obtains data from a data source and a second data stream of the set of data streams writes data to a data sink;
obtaining, by the streaming data processing system, a second input defining a processing pipeline, wherein the processing pipeline performs one or more data transformations, wherein the processing pipeline obtains data from the first data stream and writes data to the second data stream;
receiving, by the streaming data processing system, a set of data from the data source;
based at least in part on the first input, routing, by the streaming data processing system, the set of data from the data source to the processing pipeline via the first data stream, wherein the set of data is compatible with a first stream schema of the set of stream schemas associated with the first data stream;
based at least in part on the second input, performing, by the streaming data processing system, the one or more data transformations on the set of data to generate a set of transformed data; and
based at least in part on the first input, routing, by the streaming data processing system, the set of transformed data from the processing pipeline to the data sink via the second data stream.
Clause 2. The method of Clause 1, wherein the first data stream comprises a first user defined data stream and the second data stream comprises a second user defined data stream.
Clause 3. The method of Clause 1, wherein the data source comprises a batch source or a streaming source.
Clause 4. The method of Clause 1, wherein the data source comprises a first data source and the data sink comprises a second data sink, wherein a third data stream of the set of data streams obtains data from a second data source and a fourth data stream of the set of data streams writes data to a second data sink, wherein the processing pipeline comprises a first pipeline, wherein the one or more data transformations comprise one or more first data transformations, wherein the set of data comprises a first set of data, wherein the set of transformed data comprises a first set of transformed data, the method further comprising:
obtaining, by the streaming data processing system, a third input defining a second processing pipeline, wherein the second processing pipeline performs one or more second data transformations, wherein the second processing pipeline obtains data from the third data stream and writes data to the fourth data stream;
receiving, by the streaming data processing system, a second set of data from the second data source;
routing, by the streaming data processing system, the second set of data from the second data source to the second processing pipeline via the third data stream;
based at least in part on the third input, performing, by the streaming data processing system, the one or more second data transformations on the second set of data to generate a second set of transformed data; and routing, by the streaming data processing system, the second set of transformed data from the second processing pipeline to the second data sink via the fourth data stream.
Clause 5. The method of Clause 1, wherein the second input indicates that the processing pipeline obtains data from the first data stream and writes data to the second data stream.
Clause 6. The method of Clause 1, wherein the processing pipeline obtains data from a plurality of data streams, the plurality of data streams comprising the first data stream.
Clause 7. The method of Clause 1, wherein the processing pipeline writes data to a plurality of data streams, the plurality of data streams comprising the second data stream.
Clause 8. The method of Clause 1, wherein the first input comprises one or more of a stream name, a storage quota, a data retention policy, or a read/write throughput rate.
Clause 9. The method of Clause 1, wherein the set of data comprises a first set of data, the method further comprising:
obtaining, by the streaming data processing system, a third input defining an updated first data stream, wherein the updated first data stream comprises an update to the first data stream, wherein the updated first data stream obtains data from an updated data source;
receiving, by the streaming data processing system, a second set of data from the updated data source; and
based at least in part on the third input, routing, by the streaming data processing system, the second set of data from the updated data source to the processing pipeline via the updated first data stream.
Clause 10. The method of Clause 1, wherein one or more of the first data stream or the second data stream is associated with a topic.
Clause 11. The method of Clause 1, wherein the first input is defined by a graphical control.
Clause 12. The method of Clause 1, wherein the second input is defined by a graphical control.
Clause 13. The method of Clause 1, wherein one or more of the first data stream or the second data stream comprises an ingestion buffer.
Clause 14. The method of Clause 1, wherein one or more of the first data stream or the second data stream comprises an ingestion buffer, wherein one or more of the first data stream or second data stream is associated with buffer criteria, wherein the buffer criteria indicates one or more of source or sourcetype of one or more of the first data stream or the second data stream.
Clause 15. A computing system of a data ingestion system, the computing system comprising:
a streaming data processing system configured to:
Clause 16. The computing system of Clause 15, wherein the first data stream comprises a first user defined data stream and the second data stream comprises a second user defined data stream.
Clause 17. The computing system of Clause 15, wherein the processing pipeline comprises an ingestion buffer.
Clause 18. Non-transitory computer readable media comprising computer-executable instructions that, when executed by a computing system of a streaming data processing system, cause the computing system to:
obtain a first input defining a set of data streams and a set of stream schemas, wherein each stream schema of the set of stream schemas defines how a corresponding data stream routes data, wherein a first data stream of the set of data streams obtains data from a data source and a second data stream of the set of data streams writes data to a data sink;
obtain a second input defining a processing pipeline, wherein the processing pipeline performs one or more data transformations, wherein the processing pipeline obtains data from the first data stream and writes data to the second data stream;
receive a set of data from the data source;
based at least in part on the first input, route the set of data from the data source to the processing pipeline via the first data stream, wherein the set of data is compatible with a first stream schema of the set of stream schemas associated with the first data stream;
based at least in part on the second input, perform the one or more data transformations on the set of data to generate a set of transformed data; and
based at least in part on the first input, route the set of transformed data from the processing pipeline to the data sink via the second data stream.
Clause 19. The non-transitory computer readable media of Clause 18, wherein the first input is defined by a graphical control.
Clause 20. The non-transitory computer readable media of Clause 18, wherein the second input is defined by a graphical control.
Clause 21. A method, comprising:
causing display of a first graphical control of a graphical user interface on a display device, the first graphical control enabling a user to define one or more data streams;
causing display of a second graphical control of the graphical user interface on the display device, the second graphical control enabling the user to define one or more processing pipelines, the second graphical control further enabling the user to specify a data route that comprises the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines;
implementing the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines based on the data route, wherein each processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines performs one or more corresponding data transformations, wherein each data stream of the one or more data streams obtains data from one or more of a first processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines or a data source and writes the data to one or more of a second processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines or a data sink; and
routing a set of data based at least in part on the data route specified by the second graphical control.
Clause 22. The method of Clause 21, wherein a data stream of the one or more data streams obtains the data from the first processing pipeline and writes the data to the second processing pipeline.
Clause 23. The method of Clause 21, wherein a data stream of the one or more data streams obtains the data from the data source and writes the data to the data sink.
Clause 24. The method of Clause 21, wherein the processing pipeline obtains data from a first externally defined data stream and writes data to a second externally defined data stream.
Clause 25. The method of Clause 21, wherein the processing pipeline obtains data from a first data stream of the one or more data streams and writes data to a second data stream of the one or more data streams.
Clause 26. The method of Clause 21, wherein the data route indicates a relationship between the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines.
Clause 27. The method of Clause 21, wherein a processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines obtains data from a plurality of data streams of the one or more data streams.
Clause 28. The method of Clause 21, wherein a processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines writes data to a plurality of data streams of the one or more data streams.
Clause 29. The method of Clause 21, wherein the first graphical control enables the user to define one or more of a stream name, a storage quota, a data retention policy, or a read/write throughput rate.
Clause 30. The method of Clause 21, wherein the one or more data streams are associated with a topic.
Clause 31. The method of Clause 21, wherein the one or more data streams comprise one or more ingestion buffers.
Clause 32. The method of Clause 21, wherein the one or more data streams comprise one or more ingestion buffers, wherein the one or more data streams are associated with buffer criteria, wherein the buffer criteria indicates one or more of source or sourcetype of the one or more data streams.
Clause 33. A computing system comprising:
memory;
a display device; and
one or more processing devices coupled to the memory and configured to:
Clause 34. The computing system of Clause 33, wherein the data route indicates a relationship between the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines.
Clause 35. The computing system of Clause 33, wherein a data stream of the one or more data streams obtains the data from the first processing pipeline and writes the data to the second processing pipeline.
Clause 36. The computing system of Clause 33, wherein a data stream of the one or more data streams obtains the data from the data source and writes the data to the data sink.
Clause 37. Non-transitory computer readable media comprising computer-executable instructions that, when executed by a computing system of a streaming data processing system, cause the computing system to:
cause display of a first graphical control of a first graphical user interface on a display device, the first graphical control enabling a user to define one or more data streams;
cause display of a second graphical control of a second graphical user interface on the display device, the second graphical control enabling the user to define one or more processing pipelines, the second graphical control further enabling the user to specify a data route that comprises the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines;
implement the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines based on the data route, wherein each processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines performs one or more corresponding data transformations, wherein each data stream of the one or more data streams obtains data from one or more of a first processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines or a data source and writes the data to one or more of a second processing pipeline of the one or more processing pipelines or a data sink; and
route a set of data based at least in part on the data route specified by the second graphical control.
Clause 38. The non-transitory computer readable media of Clause 37, wherein the data route indicates a relationship between the one or more data streams and the one or more processing pipelines.
Clause 39. The non-transitory computer readable media of Clause 37, wherein a data stream of the one or more data streams obtains the data from the first processing pipeline and writes the data to the second processing pipeline.
Clause 40. The non-transitory computer readable media of Clause 37, wherein a data stream of the one or more data streams obtains the data from the data source and writes the data to the data sink.
Clause 41. A method comprising:
obtaining, by a streaming data processing system, a first input defining a first processing pipeline and a second processing pipeline, wherein the first processing pipeline performs one or more first data transformations and the second processing pipeline performs one or more second data transformations, wherein the first processing pipeline obtains a set of data from a first externally defined data stream and writes a first set of transformed data to a user defined data stream, wherein the second processing pipeline obtains the first set of transformed data from the user defined data stream and writes a second set of transformed data to a second externally defined data stream;
obtaining, by the streaming data processing system, a second input defining the user defined data stream that obtains the first set of transformed data from the first processing pipeline and writes the first set of transformed data to the second processing pipeline;
receiving, by the streaming data processing system, the set of data from the first externally defined data stream;
based at least in part on the first input, performing, by the streaming data processing system, the one or more first data transformations on the set of data to generate the first set of transformed data; and
based at least in part on the second input, routing, by the streaming data processing system, the first set of transformed data from the first processing pipeline to the second processing pipeline via the user defined data stream;
based at least in part on the first input, performing, by the streaming data processing system, the one or more second data transformations on the first set of transformed data to generate the second set of transformed data; and
based at least in part on the first input, routing, by the streaming data processing system, the second set of transformed data to the second externally defined data stream via the second processing pipeline.
Clause 42. The method of Clause 41, wherein one or more of the first externally defined data stream or the second externally defined data stream comprises a stream of data from a block storage service.
Clause 43. The method of Clause 41, wherein the user defined data stream comprises a first user defined data stream, wherein a second user defined data stream obtains a third set of transformed data from a third processing pipeline and writes the third set of transformed data to a fourth processing pipeline, wherein the set of data comprises a first set of data, the method further comprising:
receiving, by the streaming data processing system, a second set of data from a third externally defined data stream;
performing, by the streaming data processing system, one or more second data transformations on the second set of data to generate the third set of transformed data; and
routing, by the streaming data processing system, the third set of transformed data from the third processing pipeline to the fourth processing pipeline via the second user defined data stream.
Clause 44. The method of Clause 41, wherein the first input indicates that the first processing pipeline obtains a set of data from a first externally defined data stream and writes a first set of transformed data to a user defined data stream and the second processing pipeline obtains the first set of transformed data from the user defined data stream and writes the second set of transformed data to the second externally defined data stream.
Clause 45. The method of Clause 41, wherein the first processing pipeline obtains data from a plurality of externally defined data streams, the plurality of externally defined data streams comprising the first externally defined data stream.
Clause 46. The method of Clause 41, wherein the second processing pipeline writes data to a plurality of externally defined data streams, the plurality of externally defined data streams comprising the second externally defined data stream.
Clause 47. The method of Clause 41, wherein the second input comprises one or more of a stream name, a storage quota, a data retention policy, or a read/write throughput rate.
Clause 48. The method of Clause 41, wherein the user defined data stream is customizable.
Clause 49. The method of Clause 41, wherein the user defined data stream is associated with a topic.
Clause 50. The method of Clause 41, wherein the first input is defined by a graphical control.
Clause 51. The method of Clause 41, wherein the second input is defined by a graphical control.
Clause 52. The method of Clause 41, wherein the user defined data stream comprises an ingestion buffer.
Clause 53. The method of Clause 41, wherein the user defined data stream comprises an ingestion buffer, wherein the user defined data stream is associated with buffer criteria, wherein the buffer criteria indicates one or more of source or sourcetype for the user defined data stream.
Clause 54. A computing system of a data ingestion system, the computing system comprising:
a streaming data processing system configured to:
Clause 55. The computing system of Clause 54, wherein the first processing pipeline obtains data from a plurality of externally defined data streams, the plurality of externally defined data streams comprising the first externally defined data stream.
Clause 56. The computing system of Clause 54, wherein the second processing pipeline writes data to a plurality of externally defined data streams, the plurality of externally defined data streams comprising the second externally defined data stream.
Clause 57. The computing system of Clause 54, wherein the user defined data stream is customizable.
Clause 58. Non-transitory computer readable media comprising computer-executable instructions that, when executed by a computing system of a streaming data processing system, cause the computing system to:
obtain a first input defining a first processing pipeline and a second processing pipeline, wherein the first processing pipeline performs one or more first data transformations and the second processing pipeline performs one or more second data transformations, wherein the first processing pipeline obtains a set of data from a first externally defined data stream and writes a first set of transformed data to a user defined data stream, wherein the second processing pipeline obtains the first set of transformed data from the user defined data stream and writes a second set of transformed data to a second externally defined data stream;
obtain a second input defining the user defined data stream that obtains the first set of transformed data from the first processing pipeline and writes the first set of transformed data to the second processing pipeline;
receive the set of data from the first externally defined data stream;
based at least in part on the first input, perform the one or more first data transformations on the set of data to generate the first set of transformed data; and
based at least in part on the second input, route the first set of transformed data from the first processing pipeline to the second processing pipeline via the user defined data stream;
based at least in part on the first input, perform the one or more second data transformations on the first set of transformed data to generate the second set of transformed data; and
based at least in part on the first input, route the second set of transformed data to the second externally defined data stream via the second processing pipeline.
Clause 59. The non-transitory computer readable media of Clause 58, wherein the user defined data stream is customizable.
Clause 60. The non-transitory computer readable media of Clause 58, wherein the second input comprises one or more of a stream name, a storage quota, a data retention policy, or a read/write throughput rate.
Any of the above methods may be embodied within computer-executable instructions which may be stored within a data store or non-transitory computer-readable media and executed by a computing system (e.g., a processor of such system) to implement the respective methods.
Kulkarni, Sanjeev, Peng, Boyang, Ramasamy, Karthikeyan, Devaraj, Poornima
Patent | Priority | Assignee | Title |
11886440, | Jul 16 2019 | SPLUNK Inc. | Guided creation interface for streaming data processing pipelines |
Patent | Priority | Assignee | Title |
10049160, | May 03 2013 | SPLUNK Inc. | Processing a system search request across disparate data collection systems |
10127258, | Sep 30 2014 | SPLUNK Inc. | Event time selection output techniques |
10223176, | Oct 13 2017 | Amazon Technologies, Inc. | Event handler nodes for visual scripting |
10360196, | Apr 15 2014 | SPLUNK Inc.; SPLUNK INC | Grouping and managing event streams generated from captured network data |
10437653, | Oct 10 2017 | The Boeing Company | Efficient event notification |
10574548, | Jul 31 2013 | SPLUNK, INC | Key indicators view |
10614132, | Apr 30 2013 | SPLUNK INC | GUI-triggered processing of performance data and log data from an information technology environment |
10691523, | Sep 07 2012 | SPLUNK Inc. | Generating notification visualizations based on event pattern matching |
10749782, | Sep 10 2016 | SIGNALFX LLC; SPLUNK INC | Analyzing servers based on data streams generated by instrumented software executing on the servers |
10761813, | Oct 01 2018 | SPLUNK INC | Assisted visual programming for iterative publish-subscribe message processing system |
10775976, | Oct 01 2018 | SPLUNK INC | Visual previews for programming an iterative publish-subscribe message processing system |
10776355, | Sep 26 2016 | SPLUNK INC | Managing, storing, and caching query results and partial query results for combination with additional query results |
10776441, | Oct 01 2018 | SPLUNK INC | Visual programming for iterative publish-subscribe message processing system |
10860618, | Sep 25 2017 | SPLUNK INC | Low-latency streaming analytics |
10885021, | May 02 2018 | Palantir Technologies Inc | Interactive interpreter and graphical user interface |
10936585, | Oct 31 2018 | SPLUNK INC | Unified data processing across streaming and indexed data sets |
10936643, | Feb 22 2019 | SPLUNK Inc.; SPLUNK INC | User interface with automated condensation of machine data event streams |
10984044, | Sep 26 2016 | SPLUNK INC | Identifying buckets for query execution using a catalog of buckets stored in a remote shared storage system |
10997180, | Jan 31 2018 | SPLUNK Inc. | Dynamic query processor for streaming and batch queries |
11003714, | Sep 26 2016 | SPLUNK INC | Search node and bucket identification using a search node catalog and a data store catalog |
11106734, | Sep 26 2016 | SPLUNK INC | Query execution using containerized state-free search nodes in a containerized scalable environment |
11113353, | Oct 01 2018 | SPLUNK Inc. | Visual programming for iterative message processing system |
11194552, | Oct 01 2018 | SPLUNK Inc. | Assisted visual programming for iterative message processing system |
11238048, | Jul 16 2019 | SPLUNK INC | Guided creation interface for streaming data processing pipelines |
11269939, | Sep 26 2016 | SPLUNK INC | Iterative message-based data processing including streaming analytics |
11294941, | Sep 26 2016 | SPLUNK Inc.; SPLUNK INC | Message-based data ingestion to a data intake and query system |
11347747, | Jan 14 2021 | EMC IP HOLDING COMPANY LLC | Ordering data stream events in a streaming data storage platform |
11386127, | Sep 25 2017 | SPLUNK Inc. | Low-latency streaming analytics |
6154781, | Dec 24 1998 | International Business Machines Corporation | Publish and subscribe data processing with subscriber option to request subscription propagation prior to acknowledgement |
6671795, | Jan 21 2000 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatus for pausing execution in a processor or the like |
6938147, | May 11 1999 | Oracle America, Inc | Processor with multiple-thread, vertically-threaded pipeline |
7685281, | Feb 13 2004 | Oracle International Corporation | Programmatic instantiation, provisioning and management of fabric-backplane enterprise servers |
7702610, | Sep 19 2003 | International Business Machines Corporation | Performing sequence analysis as a multipart plan storing intermediate results as a relation |
7895359, | May 01 2003 | GOLDMAN SACHS & CO LLC | System and method for message processing and routing |
7937344, | Jul 25 2005 | SPLUNK INC | Machine data web |
8065319, | Apr 01 2007 | NEC Corporation | Runtime semantic query optimization for event stream processing |
8112425, | Oct 05 2006 | SPLUNK INC | Time series search engine |
8412696, | Jan 31 2011 | SPLUNK Inc.; SPLUNK INC | Real time searching and reporting |
8504620, | Nov 30 2000 | Applied Materials, Inc. | Dynamic subject information generation in message services of distributed object systems |
8589375, | Jan 31 2011 | SPLUNK INC | Real time searching and reporting |
8589403, | Feb 28 2011 | SPLUNK Inc.; SPLUNK INC | Compressed journaling in event tracking files for metadata recovery and replication |
8589432, | Jan 31 2011 | SPLUNK Inc. | Real time searching and reporting |
8682925, | Jan 31 2013 | SPLUNK INC; SPLUNK Inc. | Distributed high performance analytics store |
8738587, | May 03 2013 | SPLUNK Inc. | Processing a system search request by retrieving results from both a native index and a virtual index |
8738629, | May 03 2013 | SPLUNK Inc.; SPLUNK INC | External Result Provided process for retrieving data stored using a different configuration or protocol |
8751529, | Mar 14 2011 | SPLUNK Inc. | Scalable interactive display of distributed data |
8788525, | Sep 07 2012 | SPLUNK INC | Data model for machine data for semantic search |
8788526, | Sep 07 2012 | SPLUNK Inc. | Data model for machine data for semantic search |
8793225, | May 03 2013 | SPLUNK Inc.; SPLUNK INC | Processing a system search request including external data sources and mixed modes |
8826434, | Jul 25 2013 | SPLUNK INC | Security threat detection based on indications in big data of access to newly registered domains |
8924476, | Mar 30 2012 | GOOGLE LLC | Recovery and fault-tolerance of a real time in-memory index |
8983994, | Sep 07 2012 | SPLUNK Inc. | Generation of a data model for searching machine data |
9026903, | Jan 11 2011 | GOOGLE LLC | Abstract syntax tree interpreter for generating a valid HTML document |
9124612, | May 15 2012 | SPLUNK Inc.; SPLUNK, INC | Multi-site clustering |
9128980, | Sep 07 2012 | SPLUNK Inc. | Generation of a data model applied to queries |
9128985, | Jan 13 2013 | SPLUNK, Inc. | Supplementing a high performance analytics store with evaluation of individual events to respond to an event query |
9130971, | May 15 2012 | SPLUNK, Inc.; SPLUNK, INC | Site-based search affinity |
9173801, | Jul 25 2013 | SPLUNK, Inc. | Graphic display of security threats based on indications of access to newly registered domains |
9185007, | Apr 30 2013 | SPLUNK Inc. | Proactive monitoring tree with severity state sorting |
9215240, | Jul 25 2013 | SPLUNK INC | Investigative and dynamic detection of potential security-threat indicators from events in big data |
9248068, | Jul 25 2013 | SPLUNK Inc. | Security threat detection of newly registered domains |
9286413, | Oct 09 2014 | SPLUNK Inc. | Presenting a service-monitoring dashboard using key performance indicators derived from machine data |
9367501, | Nov 10 2011 | International Business Machines Corporation | Dynamic streaming data dispatcher |
9426045, | Apr 30 2013 | SPLUNK Inc. | Proactive monitoring tree with severity state sorting |
9426172, | Jul 25 2013 | SPLUNK Inc. | Security threat detection using domain name accesses |
9432396, | Jul 25 2013 | SPLUNK Inc. | Security threat detection using domain name registrations |
9514189, | May 03 2013 | SPLUNK Inc. | Processing a system search request including external data sources |
9537692, | Aug 31 2005 | ABB Patent GmbH | Automation device operable to convert between data byte streams and frequency modulated line signals |
9589012, | Sep 07 2012 | SPLUNK Inc. | Generation of a data model applied to object queries |
9838292, | Sep 19 2014 | SPLUNK Inc.; SPLUNK, INC | Utilizing packet headers to monitor network traffic in association with a client device |
9892020, | Mar 11 2016 | SIGNALFX LLC; SPLUNK INC | User interface for specifying data stream processing language programs for analyzing instrumented software |
9990386, | Jan 31 2013 | SPLUNK Inc. | Generating and storing summarization tables for sets of searchable events |
20020070968, | |||
20030130993, | |||
20030217119, | |||
20040017395, | |||
20040064818, | |||
20050022207, | |||
20050076067, | |||
20060069717, | |||
20070168336, | |||
20070198641, | |||
20080010337, | |||
20080189332, | |||
20110173184, | |||
20110320550, | |||
20120079004, | |||
20120197934, | |||
20120284331, | |||
20130066674, | |||
20130318236, | |||
20140149725, | |||
20140324862, | |||
20140359569, | |||
20150019537, | |||
20150149507, | |||
20150207857, | |||
20150213631, | |||
20150304879, | |||
20150379672, | |||
20160048408, | |||
20160050261, | |||
20160062736, | |||
20160085810, | |||
20160103659, | |||
20160117158, | |||
20160140205, | |||
20160179884, | |||
20160203135, | |||
20160224459, | |||
20160268013, | |||
20160286013, | |||
20160291942, | |||
20160364093, | |||
20170006135, | |||
20170012909, | |||
20170024912, | |||
20170046374, | |||
20170083588, | |||
20170103103, | |||
20170104819, | |||
20170109378, | |||
20170124166, | |||
20170180289, | |||
20170199809, | |||
20170220685, | |||
20170243132, | |||
20170351585, | |||
20180011655, | |||
20180074752, | |||
20180074870, | |||
20180089324, | |||
20180113783, | |||
20180189642, | |||
20180329644, | |||
20180332367, | |||
20190095510, | |||
20190098106, | |||
20190109848, | |||
20190230153, | |||
20190236194, | |||
20190349426, | |||
20190355022, | |||
20190377816, | |||
20190379650, | |||
20190384659, | |||
20190384836, | |||
20200034468, | |||
20200089529, | |||
20200274915, | |||
20200356676, | |||
20210034615, | |||
20210232579, | |||
20210342125, | |||
20220004557, | |||
20220245156, | |||
20220247695, | |||
CN106991011, | |||
DE60002200, | |||
WO2019195969, | |||
WO2021222395, | |||
WO2022164925, |
Executed on | Assignor | Assignee | Conveyance | Frame | Reel | Doc |
Mar 26 2021 | KULKARNI, SANJEEV | SPLUNK INC | ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS | 058532 | /0622 | |
Mar 26 2021 | PENG, BOYANG | SPLUNK INC | ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS | 058532 | /0622 | |
Apr 02 2021 | RAMASAMY, KARTHIKEYAN | SPLUNK INC | ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS | 058532 | /0622 | |
Apr 28 2021 | SPLUNK Inc. | (assignment on the face of the patent) | / | |||
Jan 21 2022 | DEVARAJ, POORNIMA | SPLUNK INC | ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS | 058758 | /0405 |
Date | Maintenance Fee Events |
Apr 28 2021 | BIG: Entity status set to Undiscounted (note the period is included in the code). |
Date | Maintenance Schedule |
Apr 25 2026 | 4 years fee payment window open |
Oct 25 2026 | 6 months grace period start (w surcharge) |
Apr 25 2027 | patent expiry (for year 4) |
Apr 25 2029 | 2 years to revive unintentionally abandoned end. (for year 4) |
Apr 25 2030 | 8 years fee payment window open |
Oct 25 2030 | 6 months grace period start (w surcharge) |
Apr 25 2031 | patent expiry (for year 8) |
Apr 25 2033 | 2 years to revive unintentionally abandoned end. (for year 8) |
Apr 25 2034 | 12 years fee payment window open |
Oct 25 2034 | 6 months grace period start (w surcharge) |
Apr 25 2035 | patent expiry (for year 12) |
Apr 25 2037 | 2 years to revive unintentionally abandoned end. (for year 12) |